]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - src/xterm.c
(x_new_font): Set FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH to
[gnu-emacs] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000,01,02,03,04
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
21
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
24
25 #include <config.h>
26
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
30
31 #include <stdio.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
59
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
69
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
88
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
92
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
99
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
103
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
108
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
110
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
115
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
121
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
123
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
129
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #define XAW_ARROW_SCROLLBARS
135 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
136 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
139 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #ifndef XtNpickTop
141 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
142 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
143 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
144 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
145
146 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
147
148 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
149 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
151 #endif
152
153 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
154 #include "widget.h"
155 #ifndef XtNinitialState
156 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
157 #endif
158 #endif
159
160 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
161
162 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
163 #ifdef USE_XIM
164 int use_xim = 1;
165 #else
166 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
167 #endif
168
169 \f
170
171 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
172
173 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
174
175 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
176 start. */
177
178 static int any_help_event_p;
179
180 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
181 static Lisp_Object last_window;
182
183 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
184
185 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
186
187 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
188 use. */
189
190 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
191
192 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
193 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
194 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
195 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
196
197 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
198
199 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
200 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
201 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
202 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
203
204 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
205
206 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
207
208 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
209
210 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
211 /* The application context for Xt use. */
212 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
213 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
215
216 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
217
218 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
219
220 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
221 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
222
223 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
224
225 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
226 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
227 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
228
229 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
230
231 /* Mouse movement.
232
233 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
234 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
235 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
236 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
237
238 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
239
240 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
241 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
242 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
243 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
244 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
245 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
246 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
247 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
248 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
249 is off. */
250
251 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
252
253 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
254 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
255
256 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
257
258 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
259 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
260 an ordinary motion.
261
262 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
263 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
264 event. */
265
266 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
267
268 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
269 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
270 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
271 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
272 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
273 it's somewhat accurate. */
274
275 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
276
277 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
278 events. */
279
280 #ifdef __STDC__
281 static int volatile input_signal_count;
282 #else
283 static int input_signal_count;
284 #endif
285
286 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
287
288 static int x_noop_count;
289
290 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
291
292 extern char **initial_argv;
293 extern int initial_argc;
294
295 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
296
297 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
298
299 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
300
301 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
302
303 extern int errno;
304
305 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
306
307 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
308
309 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
310
311 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
312 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
313 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
314
315 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
316 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
317
318 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
319 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
320
321 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
322 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
323 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
324 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
325 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
326 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
327 unsigned));
328 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
329 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
330 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
331 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
332 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
333 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
334 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
335 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
336 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
337 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
338 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
339 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
340 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
341 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
345 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
346 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
347 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
348 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
350 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
351 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
352 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
353 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
354 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
355 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
356 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
357 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
358 enum text_cursor_kinds));
359
360 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
361 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
362 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
363 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
364 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
365 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
366 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
367 enum scroll_bar_part *,
368 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
369 unsigned long *));
370 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
371 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
372 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
373 int *, struct input_event *));
374
375
376 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
377
378 static void
379 x_flush (f)
380 struct frame *f;
381 {
382 BLOCK_INPUT;
383 if (f == NULL)
384 {
385 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
386 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
387 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
388 }
389 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
390 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
391 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
392 }
393
394
395 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
396 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
397 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
398 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
399 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
400 performance. */
401
402 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
403
404 \f
405 /***********************************************************************
406 Debugging
407 ***********************************************************************/
408
409 #if 0
410
411 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
412 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
413
414 struct record
415 {
416 char *locus;
417 int type;
418 };
419
420 struct record event_record[100];
421
422 int event_record_index;
423
424 record_event (locus, type)
425 char *locus;
426 int type;
427 {
428 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
429 event_record_index = 0;
430
431 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
432 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
433 event_record_index++;
434 }
435
436 #endif /* 0 */
437
438
439 \f
440 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
441
442 struct x_display_info *
443 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
444 Display *dpy;
445 {
446 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
447
448 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
449 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
450 return dpyinfo;
451
452 return 0;
453 }
454
455
456 \f
457 /***********************************************************************
458 Starting and ending an update
459 ***********************************************************************/
460
461 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
462 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
463 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
464 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
465 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
466
467 static void
468 x_update_begin (f)
469 struct frame *f;
470 {
471 /* Nothing to do. */
472 }
473
474
475 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
476 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
477 position of W. */
478
479 static void
480 x_update_window_begin (w)
481 struct window *w;
482 {
483 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
484 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
485
486 updated_window = w;
487 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
488
489 BLOCK_INPUT;
490
491 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
492 {
493 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
494 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
495
496 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
497 highlighting. */
498 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
499 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
500
501 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
502 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
503 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
504 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
505 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
506 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
507
508 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
509 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
510 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
511 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
512 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
513 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
514 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
515 {
516 int i;
517
518 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
519 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
520 break;
521
522 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
523 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
524 }
525 #endif /* 0 */
526 }
527
528 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
529 }
530
531
532 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
533
534 static void
535 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
536 struct window *w;
537 int x, y0, y1;
538 {
539 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
540
541 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
542 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
543 }
544
545 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
546
547 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
548 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
549
550 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
551 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
552 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
553
554 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
555 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
556 here. */
557
558 static void
559 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
560 struct window *w;
561 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
562 {
563 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
564
565 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
566 {
567 BLOCK_INPUT;
568
569 if (cursor_on_p)
570 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
571 output_cursor.vpos,
572 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
573
574 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
575 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
576
577 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
578 }
579
580 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
581 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
582 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
583 {
584 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
585 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
586 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
587 }
588
589 updated_window = NULL;
590 }
591
592
593 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
594 update_end. */
595
596 static void
597 x_update_end (f)
598 struct frame *f;
599 {
600 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
601 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
602
603 #ifndef XFlush
604 BLOCK_INPUT;
605 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
606 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
607 #endif
608 }
609
610
611 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
612 complete update has been performed. The global variable
613 updated_window is not available here. */
614
615 static void
616 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
617 struct frame *f;
618 {
619 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
620 {
621 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
622
623 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
624 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
625 {
626 BLOCK_INPUT;
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
628 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
629 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
630 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
631 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
632 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
633 }
634 }
635 }
636
637
638 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
639 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
640 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
641 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
642 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
643 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
644
645 static void
646 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
647 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
648 {
649 struct window *w = updated_window;
650 struct frame *f;
651 int width, height;
652
653 xassert (w);
654
655 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
656 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
657
658 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
659 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
660 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
661 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
662 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
663 overhead is very small. */
664 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
665 && desired_row->full_width_p
666 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
667 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
668 width != 0)
669 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
670 height > 0))
671 {
672 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
673
674 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
675 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
676 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
677 y -= width;
678
679 BLOCK_INPUT;
680 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
681 0, y, width, height, False);
682 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
683 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
684 y, width, height, False);
685 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
686 }
687 }
688
689 static void
690 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
691 struct window *w;
692 struct glyph_row *row;
693 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
694 {
695 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
696 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
697 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
698 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
699 struct face *face = p->face;
700 int rowY;
701
702 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
703 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
704 if (p->y < rowY)
705 {
706 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
707 visible last row. */
708 int oldY = row->y;
709 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
710 row->visible_height = p->h;
711 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
712 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
713 row->y = oldY;
714 row->visible_height = oldVH;
715 }
716 else
717 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
718
719 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
720 {
721 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
722 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
723 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
724 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
725 if (face->stipple)
726 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
727 else
728 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
729
730 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
731 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
732
733 if (!face->stipple)
734 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
735 }
736
737 if (p->which)
738 {
739 unsigned char *bits;
740 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
741 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
742 XGCValues gcv;
743
744 if (p->wd > 8)
745 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
746 else
747 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
748
749 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
750 by the server. */
751 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
752 (p->cursor_p
753 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
754 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
755 : face->foreground),
756 face->background, depth);
757
758 if (p->overlay_p)
759 {
760 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
761 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
762 bits, p->wd, p->h,
763 1, 0, 1);
764 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
765 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
766 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
767 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
768 }
769
770 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
771 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
772 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
773
774 if (p->overlay_p)
775 {
776 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
777 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
778 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
779 }
780 }
781
782 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
783 }
784
785 \f
786
787 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
788 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
789 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
790 rarely happens). */
791
792 static void
793 XTset_terminal_modes ()
794 {
795 }
796
797 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
798 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
799
800 static void
801 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
802 {
803 }
804
805
806 \f
807 /***********************************************************************
808 Display Iterator
809 ***********************************************************************/
810
811 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
812
813 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
814
815
816 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
817 is not contained in the font. */
818
819 static XCharStruct *
820 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
821 XFontStruct *font;
822 XChar2b *char2b;
823 int font_type; /* unused on X */
824 {
825 /* The result metric information. */
826 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
827
828 xassert (font && char2b);
829
830 if (font->per_char != NULL)
831 {
832 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
833 {
834 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
835 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
836 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
837 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
838 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
839 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
840 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
841 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
842 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
843 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
844 }
845 else
846 {
847 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
848 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
849 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
850 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
851
852 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
853 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
854
855 where:
856
857 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
858 / = integer division
859 \ = integer modulus */
860 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
861 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
862 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
863 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
864 {
865 pcm = (font->per_char
866 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
867 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
868 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
869 }
870 }
871 }
872 else
873 {
874 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
875 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
876 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
877 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
878 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
879 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
880 }
881
882 return ((pcm == NULL
883 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
884 ? NULL : pcm);
885 }
886
887
888 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
889 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
890
891 static int
892 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
893 int c;
894 XChar2b *char2b;
895 struct font_info *font_info;
896 int *two_byte_p;
897 {
898 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
899 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
900
901 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
902 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
903 fixed encoding. */
904 if (font_info->font_encoder)
905 {
906 /* It's a program. */
907 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
908
909 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
910 {
911 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
912 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
913 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
914 }
915 else
916 {
917 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
918 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
919 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
920 }
921
922 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
923
924 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
925 program. */
926 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
927 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
928 else
929 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
930 }
931 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
932 {
933 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
934 encoding numbers. */
935 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
936
937 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
938 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
939 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
940
941 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
942 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
943 }
944
945 if (two_byte_p)
946 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
947
948 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
949 }
950
951
952 \f
953 /***********************************************************************
954 Glyph display
955 ***********************************************************************/
956
957
958
959 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
961 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
962 int));
963 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
964 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
968 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
972 unsigned long *, double, int));
973 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
974 double, int, unsigned long));
975 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
978 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
979 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
980 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
981 int, int, int));
982 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
983 int, int, int, int, int, int,
984 XRectangle *));
985 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
986 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
987
988 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
989 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
990 #endif
991
992
993 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
994 face. */
995
996 static void
997 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
998 struct glyph_string *s;
999 {
1000 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1001 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1002 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1003 && !s->cmp)
1004 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1005 else
1006 {
1007 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1008 XGCValues xgcv;
1009 unsigned long mask;
1010
1011 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1012 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1013
1014 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1015 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1016 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1017 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1018 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1019 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1020 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1021
1022 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1023 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1024 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1025 {
1026 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1027 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1028 }
1029
1030 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1031 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1032 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1033 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1034
1035 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1036 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1037 mask, &xgcv);
1038 else
1039 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1040 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1041
1042 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1043 }
1044 }
1045
1046
1047 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1048
1049 static void
1050 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1051 struct glyph_string *s;
1052 {
1053 int face_id;
1054 struct face *face;
1055
1056 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1057 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1058 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1059 if (face == NULL)
1060 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1061
1062 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1063 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1064 else
1065 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1066 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1067 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1068
1069 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1070 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1071 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1072 else
1073 {
1074 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1075 but font FONT. */
1076 XGCValues xgcv;
1077 unsigned long mask;
1078
1079 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1080 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1081 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1082 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1083 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1084 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1085
1086 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1087 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1088 mask, &xgcv);
1089 else
1090 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1091 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1092
1093 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1094 }
1095
1096 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1101 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1102 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1103
1104 static INLINE void
1105 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1106 struct glyph_string *s;
1107 {
1108 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1109 }
1110
1111
1112 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1113 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1114 pattern. */
1115
1116 static INLINE void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1118 struct glyph_string *s;
1119 {
1120 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1121
1122 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1123 {
1124 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1125 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1126 }
1127 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1128 {
1129 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1133 {
1134 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = 0;
1136 }
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1138 {
1139 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1141 }
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1143 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1144 {
1145 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1146 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1147 }
1148 else
1149 {
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1152 }
1153
1154 /* GC must have been set. */
1155 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1156 }
1157
1158
1159 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1160 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1161
1162 static INLINE void
1163 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1164 struct glyph_string *s;
1165 {
1166 XRectangle r;
1167 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1168 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1169 }
1170
1171
1172 /* RIF:
1173 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1174 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1175
1176 static void
1177 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1178 struct glyph_string *s;
1179 {
1180 if (s->cmp == NULL
1181 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1182 {
1183 XCharStruct cs;
1184 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1185 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1186 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1187 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1188 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1189 }
1190 }
1191
1192
1193 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1194
1195 static INLINE void
1196 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1197 struct glyph_string *s;
1198 int x, y, w, h;
1199 {
1200 XGCValues xgcv;
1201 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1202 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1204 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1205 }
1206
1207
1208 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1209 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1210 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1211 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1212 contains the first component of a composition. */
1213
1214 static void
1215 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1216 struct glyph_string *s;
1217 int force_p;
1218 {
1219 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1220 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1221 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1222 {
1223 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1224
1225 if (s->stippled_p)
1226 {
1227 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1228 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1229 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1230 s->y + box_line_width,
1231 s->background_width,
1232 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1234 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1235 }
1236 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1237 || s->font_not_found_p
1238 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1239 || force_p)
1240 {
1241 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1242 s->background_width,
1243 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1244 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1245 }
1246 }
1247 }
1248
1249
1250 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1251
1252 static void
1253 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1254 struct glyph_string *s;
1255 {
1256 int i, x;
1257
1258 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1259 of S to the right of that box line. */
1260 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1261 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1262 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1263 else
1264 x = s->x;
1265
1266 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1267 loaded. */
1268 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1269 {
1270 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1271 {
1272 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1274 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1275 s->height - 1);
1276 x += g->pixel_width;
1277 }
1278 }
1279 else
1280 {
1281 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1282 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1283
1284 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1285 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1286
1287 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1288 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1289 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1290 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1291
1292 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1293 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1294 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1295 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1296 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1297 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1298 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1299 {
1300 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1301 if (s->two_byte_p)
1302 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1303 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1304 else
1305 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1306 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1307 }
1308 else
1309 {
1310 if (s->two_byte_p)
1311 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1312 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1313 else
1314 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1315 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1316 }
1317
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 {
1320 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1321 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1322 if (s->two_byte_p)
1323 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1324 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1325 else
1326 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1327 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1328 }
1329 }
1330 }
1331
1332 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1333
1334 static void
1335 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1336 struct glyph_string *s;
1337 {
1338 int i, x;
1339
1340 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1341 of S to the right of that box line. */
1342 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1343 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1344 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1345 else
1346 x = s->x;
1347
1348 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1349 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1350 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1351 this composition. */
1352
1353 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1354 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1355 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1356 {
1357 if (s->gidx == 0)
1358 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1359 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1360 }
1361 else
1362 {
1363 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1364 {
1365 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1366 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1367 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1368 s->char2b + i, 1);
1369 if (s->face->overstrike)
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1374 }
1375 }
1376 }
1377
1378
1379 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1380
1381 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1382 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1383 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1384 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1385 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1386
1387
1388 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1389 cannot be determined. */
1390
1391 static struct frame *
1392 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1393 Widget widget;
1394 {
1395 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1396 Lisp_Object tail;
1397 struct frame *f;
1398
1399 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1400
1401 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1402 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1403 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1404 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1405 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1406 widget = XtParent (widget);
1407
1408 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1409 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1410 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1411 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1412 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1413 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1414 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1415 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1416 return f;
1417
1418 abort ();
1419 }
1420
1421
1422 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1423 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1424 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1425 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1426
1427 int
1428 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1429 Widget widget;
1430 Colormap cmap;
1431 XColor *color;
1432 {
1433 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1434 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1435 }
1436
1437
1438 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1439 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1440 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1441 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1442 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1443 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1444
1445 int
1446 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1447 Widget widget;
1448 Display *display;
1449 Colormap cmap;
1450 unsigned long *pixel;
1451 double factor;
1452 int delta;
1453 {
1454 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1455 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1456 }
1457
1458
1459 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1460 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1461
1462 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1463 {
1464 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1465 sizeof (Screen *)},
1466 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1467 sizeof (Colormap)}
1468 };
1469
1470
1471 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1473
1474 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1475
1476
1477 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1478
1479 DPY is the display we are working on.
1480
1481 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1482 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1483 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1484 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1485
1486 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1487 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1488
1489 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1490 we allocated the color or not.
1491
1492 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1493
1494 static Boolean
1495 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1496 Display *dpy;
1497 XrmValue *args;
1498 Cardinal *nargs;
1499 XrmValue *from, *to;
1500 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1501 {
1502 Screen *screen;
1503 Colormap cmap;
1504 Pixel pixel;
1505 String color_name;
1506 XColor color;
1507
1508 if (*nargs != 2)
1509 {
1510 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1511 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1512 "XtToolkitError",
1513 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1514 return False;
1515 }
1516
1517 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1518 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1519 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1520
1521 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1522 {
1523 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1524 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1525 }
1526 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1527 {
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1530 }
1531 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1532 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1533 {
1534 pixel = color.pixel;
1535 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1536 }
1537 else
1538 {
1539 String params[1];
1540 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1541
1542 params[0] = color_name;
1543 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1544 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1545 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1546 params, &nparams);
1547 return False;
1548 }
1549
1550 if (to->addr != NULL)
1551 {
1552 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1553 {
1554 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1555 return False;
1556 }
1557
1558 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1559 }
1560 else
1561 {
1562 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1563 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1564 }
1565
1566 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1567 return True;
1568 }
1569
1570
1571 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1572 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1573 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1574
1575 APP is the application context in which we work.
1576
1577 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1578 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1579 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1580
1581 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1582
1583 static void
1584 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1585 XtAppContext app;
1586 XrmValuePtr to;
1587 XtPointer closure;
1588 XrmValuePtr args;
1589 Cardinal *nargs;
1590 {
1591 if (*nargs != 2)
1592 {
1593 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1594 "XtToolkitError",
1595 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1596 NULL, NULL);
1597 }
1598 else if (closure != NULL)
1599 {
1600 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1601 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1602 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1603 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1604 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1605 }
1606 }
1607
1608
1609 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1610
1611
1612 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1613 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1614 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1615 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1616
1617 static const XColor *
1618 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1619 Display *dpy;
1620 int *ncells;
1621 {
1622 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1623
1624 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1625 {
1626 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1627 int i;
1628
1629 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1630 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 dpyinfo->color_cells
1632 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1633 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1634
1635 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1637
1638 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1639 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1640 }
1641
1642 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1643 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1644 }
1645
1646
1647 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1648 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1649
1650 void
1651 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1652 struct frame *f;
1653 XColor *colors;
1654 int ncolors;
1655 {
1656 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1657
1658 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1659 {
1660 int i;
1661 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1662 {
1663 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1664 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1665 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1666 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1667 }
1668 }
1669 else
1670 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1671 }
1672
1673
1674 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1675 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1676
1677 void
1678 x_query_color (f, color)
1679 struct frame *f;
1680 XColor *color;
1681 {
1682 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1683 }
1684
1685
1686 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1687 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1688 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1689 allocated. */
1690
1691 static int
1692 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1693 Display *dpy;
1694 Colormap cmap;
1695 XColor *color;
1696 {
1697 int rc;
1698
1699 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1700 if (rc == 0)
1701 {
1702 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1703 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1704 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1705 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1706 int nearest, i;
1707 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1708 int ncells;
1709 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1710
1711 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1712 {
1713 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1714 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1715 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1716 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1717
1718 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1719 {
1720 nearest = i;
1721 nearest_delta = delta;
1722 }
1723 }
1724
1725 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1726 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1727 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1728 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1729 }
1730 else
1731 {
1732 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1733 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1734 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1735 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1736 XColor *cached_color;
1737
1738 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1739 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1740 (cached_color->red != color->red
1741 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1742 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1743 {
1744 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1745 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1746 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1747 }
1748 }
1749
1750 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1751 if (rc)
1752 register_color (color->pixel);
1753 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1754
1755 return rc;
1756 }
1757
1758
1759 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1760 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1762 allocated. */
1763
1764 int
1765 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1766 struct frame *f;
1767 Colormap cmap;
1768 XColor *color;
1769 {
1770 gamma_correct (f, color);
1771 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1772 }
1773
1774
1775 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1776 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1777 get color reference counts right. */
1778
1779 unsigned long
1780 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1781 struct frame *f;
1782 unsigned long pixel;
1783 {
1784 XColor color;
1785
1786 color.pixel = pixel;
1787 BLOCK_INPUT;
1788 x_query_color (f, &color);
1789 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1791 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1792 register_color (pixel);
1793 #endif
1794 return color.pixel;
1795 }
1796
1797
1798 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1799 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1800 get color reference counts right. */
1801
1802 unsigned long
1803 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1804 Display *dpy;
1805 Colormap cmap;
1806 unsigned long pixel;
1807 {
1808 XColor color;
1809
1810 color.pixel = pixel;
1811 BLOCK_INPUT;
1812 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1813 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1814 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1815 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1816 register_color (pixel);
1817 #endif
1818 return color.pixel;
1819 }
1820
1821
1822 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1823 boosted.
1824
1825 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1826 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1827 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1828 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1829 use an additional additive factor.
1830
1831 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1832 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1833 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1834
1835
1836 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1837 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1838 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1839 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1840 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1841 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1842
1843 static int
1844 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1845 struct frame *f;
1846 Display *display;
1847 Colormap cmap;
1848 unsigned long *pixel;
1849 double factor;
1850 int delta;
1851 {
1852 XColor color, new;
1853 long bright;
1854 int success_p;
1855
1856 /* Get RGB color values. */
1857 color.pixel = *pixel;
1858 x_query_color (f, &color);
1859
1860 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1861 xassert (factor >= 0);
1862 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1863 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1864 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1865
1866 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1867 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1868
1869 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1870 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1871 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1872 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1873 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1874 {
1875 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1876 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1877 /* The additive adjustment. */
1878 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1879
1880 if (factor < 1)
1881 {
1882 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1883 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1884 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1885 }
1886 else
1887 {
1888 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1889 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1890 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1891 }
1892 }
1893
1894 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1895 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1896 if (success_p)
1897 {
1898 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1899 {
1900 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1901 delta to the RGB values. */
1902 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1903
1904 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1905 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1906 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1907 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1908 }
1909 else
1910 success_p = 1;
1911 *pixel = new.pixel;
1912 }
1913
1914 return success_p;
1915 }
1916
1917
1918 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1919 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1920 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1921 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1922 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1923 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1924
1925 static void
1926 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1927 struct frame *f;
1928 struct relief *relief;
1929 double factor;
1930 int delta;
1931 unsigned long default_pixel;
1932 {
1933 XGCValues xgcv;
1934 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1935 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1936 unsigned long pixel;
1937 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1938 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1939 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1940 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1941
1942 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1943 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1944
1945 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1946 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1947 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1948 if (relief->gc
1949 && relief->allocated_p)
1950 {
1951 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1952 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1953 }
1954
1955 /* Allocate new color. */
1956 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1957 pixel = background;
1958 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1959 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1960 {
1961 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1962 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1963 }
1964
1965 if (relief->gc == 0)
1966 {
1967 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1968 mask |= GCStipple;
1969 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1970 }
1971 else
1972 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1973 }
1974
1975
1976 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1977
1978 static void
1979 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1980 struct glyph_string *s;
1981 {
1982 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1983 unsigned long color;
1984
1985 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1986 color = s->face->box_color;
1987 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1988 && s->img->pixmap
1989 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1990 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1991 else
1992 {
1993 XGCValues xgcv;
1994
1995 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1996 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1997 color = xgcv.background;
1998 }
1999
2000 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2001 || color != di->relief_background)
2002 {
2003 di->relief_background = color;
2004 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2005 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2006 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2007 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2008 }
2009 }
2010
2011
2012 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2013 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2014 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2015 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2016 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2017 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2018 when drawing. */
2019
2020 static void
2021 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2022 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2023 struct frame *f;
2024 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2025 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2026 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2027 {
2028 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2029 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2030 int i;
2031 GC gc;
2032
2033 if (raised_p)
2034 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2035 else
2036 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2037 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2038
2039 /* Top. */
2040 if (top_p)
2041 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2042 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2043 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2044 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2045
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2048 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2051
2052 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2053 if (raised_p)
2054 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2055 else
2056 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2057 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2058
2059 /* Bottom. */
2060 if (bot_p)
2061 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2062 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2063 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2064 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2065
2066 /* Right. */
2067 if (right_p)
2068 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2069 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2070 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2071
2072 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2073 }
2074
2075
2076 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2077 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2078 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2079 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2080 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2081 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2082
2083 static void
2084 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2085 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2086 struct glyph_string *s;
2087 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2088 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2089 {
2090 XGCValues xgcv;
2091
2092 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2093 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2094 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2095
2096 /* Top. */
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2099
2100 /* Left. */
2101 if (left_p)
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2104
2105 /* Bottom. */
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2108
2109 /* Right. */
2110 if (right_p)
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2113
2114 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2115 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2116 }
2117
2118
2119 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2120
2121 static void
2122 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2123 struct glyph_string *s;
2124 {
2125 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2126 int left_p, right_p;
2127 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2128 XRectangle clip_rect;
2129
2130 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2131 if (s->row->full_width_p
2132 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2133 {
2134 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2135 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2136 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2137 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2138 }
2139
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2144
2145 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2153
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2162
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2164
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2169 {
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2173 }
2174 }
2175
2176
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2178
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2181 struct glyph_string *s;
2182 {
2183 int x = s->x;
2184 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2185
2186 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2187 right of that line. */
2188 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2189 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2190 && s->slice.x == 0)
2191 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2192
2193 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2194 by that margin. */
2195 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2196 x += s->img->hmargin;
2197 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2198 y += s->img->vmargin;
2199
2200 if (s->img->pixmap)
2201 {
2202 if (s->img->mask)
2203 {
2204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2206 trust on the shape extension to be available
2207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2208 manually. */
2209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2210 | GCFunction);
2211 XGCValues xgcv;
2212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2213
2214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2219
2220 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2221 image_rect.x = x;
2222 image_rect.y = y;
2223 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2224 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2227 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2228 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2229 }
2230 else
2231 {
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2233
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2235 image_rect.x = x;
2236 image_rect.y = y;
2237 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2238 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2239 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2240 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2241 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2242 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2243
2244 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2245 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2246 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2247 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2248 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2249 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2250 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2251 {
2252 int r = s->img->relief;
2253 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2254 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2255 x - r, y - r,
2256 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2257 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2258 }
2259 }
2260 }
2261 else
2262 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2263 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2264 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2265 }
2266
2267
2268 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2269
2270 static void
2271 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2272 struct glyph_string *s;
2273 {
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 XRectangle r;
2276 int x = s->x;
2277 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2278
2279 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2280 right of that line. */
2281 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2282 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2283 && s->slice.x == 0)
2284 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2285
2286 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2287 by that margin. */
2288 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2289 x += s->img->hmargin;
2290 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2291 y += s->img->vmargin;
2292
2293 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2294 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2295 {
2296 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2297 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2298 }
2299 else
2300 {
2301 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2302 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2303 }
2304
2305 x0 = x - thick;
2306 y0 = y - thick;
2307 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2308 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2309
2310 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2311 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2312 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2313 s->slice.y == 0,
2314 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2315 s->slice.x == 0,
2316 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2317 &r);
2318 }
2319
2320
2321 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2322
2323 static void
2324 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2325 struct glyph_string *s;
2326 Pixmap pixmap;
2327 {
2328 int x = 0;
2329 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2330
2331 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2332 right of that line. */
2333 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2334 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2335 && s->slice.x == 0)
2336 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2337
2338 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2339 by that margin. */
2340 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2341 x += s->img->hmargin;
2342 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2343 y += s->img->vmargin;
2344
2345 if (s->img->pixmap)
2346 {
2347 if (s->img->mask)
2348 {
2349 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2350 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2351 trust on the shape extension to be available
2352 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2353 manually. */
2354 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2355 | GCFunction);
2356 XGCValues xgcv;
2357
2358 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2359 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2360 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2361 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2362 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2363
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2367 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2368 }
2369 else
2370 {
2371 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2372 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2373 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2374
2375 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2376 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2377 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2378 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2379 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2380 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2381 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2382 {
2383 int r = s->img->relief;
2384 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2385 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2386 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2387 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2388 }
2389 }
2390 }
2391 else
2392 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2393 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2394 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2395 }
2396
2397
2398 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2399 give the rectangle to draw. */
2400
2401 static void
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2403 struct glyph_string *s;
2404 int x, y, w, h;
2405 {
2406 if (s->stippled_p)
2407 {
2408 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2409 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2410 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2411 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2412 }
2413 else
2414 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2415 }
2416
2417
2418 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2419
2420 s->y
2421 s->x +-------------------------
2422 | s->face->box
2423 |
2424 | +-------------------------
2425 | | s->img->margin
2426 | |
2427 | | +-------------------
2428 | | | the image
2429
2430 */
2431
2432 static void
2433 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2434 struct glyph_string *s;
2435 {
2436 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2440
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2446
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2457 {
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2459 {
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2465
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2470
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2474
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2477 {
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2481 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2482 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2483 }
2484 else
2485 {
2486 XGCValues xgcv;
2487 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2488 &xgcv);
2489 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2490 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2491 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2492 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2493 }
2494 }
2495 else
2496 {
2497 int x = s->x;
2498 int y = s->y;
2499
2500 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2501 && s->slice.x == 0)
2502 x += box_line_hwidth;
2503
2504 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2505 y += box_line_vwidth;
2506
2507 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2508 }
2509
2510 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2511 }
2512
2513 /* Draw the foreground. */
2514 if (pixmap != None)
2515 {
2516 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2517 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2518 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2519 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2520 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2521 }
2522 else
2523 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2524
2525 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2526 if (s->img->relief
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2528 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2529 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2530 }
2531
2532
2533 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2534
2535 static void
2536 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2537 struct glyph_string *s;
2538 {
2539 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2540 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2541
2542 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2543 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2544 {
2545 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2546 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2547 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2548
2549 /* Draw cursor. */
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2551
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width < s->background_width)
2554 {
2555 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2556 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2557 XRectangle r;
2558 GC gc;
2559
2560 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2561 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2562 {
2563 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2564 gc = s->gc;
2565 }
2566 else
2567 gc = s->face->gc;
2568
2569 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2570 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2571
2572 if (s->face->stipple)
2573 {
2574 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2575 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2576 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2577 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2578 }
2579 else
2580 {
2581 XGCValues xgcv;
2582 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2583 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2586 }
2587 }
2588 }
2589 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2590 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2591 s->height);
2592
2593 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2594 }
2595
2596
2597 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2598
2599 static void
2600 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2601 struct glyph_string *s;
2602 {
2603 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2604
2605 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2606 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2607 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2608 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2609 {
2610 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2612 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2613 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2614 }
2615
2616 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2617 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2618
2619 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2620 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2621 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2622 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2623 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2624 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2625
2626 {
2627 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2629 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2630 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2631 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2632 }
2633 else
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2635
2636 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2637 {
2638 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2639 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2640 break;
2641
2642 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2643 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2644 break;
2645
2646 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2647 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2648 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2649 else
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2651 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2652 break;
2653
2654 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2655 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 else
2658 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2659 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2660 break;
2661
2662 default:
2663 abort ();
2664 }
2665
2666 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2667 {
2668 /* Draw underline. */
2669 if (s->face->underline_p)
2670 {
2671 unsigned long tem, h;
2672 int y;
2673
2674 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2675 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2676 h = 1;
2677
2678 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2679 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2680 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2681 specs, and its default is
2682
2683 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2684 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2685
2686 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2687 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2688 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2689 else if (s->face->font)
2690 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2691 else
2692 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2693
2694 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2695 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2696 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2697 else
2698 {
2699 XGCValues xgcv;
2700 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2702 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2703 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2705 }
2706 }
2707
2708 /* Draw overline. */
2709 if (s->face->overline_p)
2710 {
2711 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2712
2713 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2714 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2715 s->width, h);
2716 else
2717 {
2718 XGCValues xgcv;
2719 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2721 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2722 s->width, h);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2724 }
2725 }
2726
2727 /* Draw strike-through. */
2728 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2729 {
2730 unsigned long h = 1;
2731 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2732
2733 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2734 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2735 s->width, h);
2736 else
2737 {
2738 XGCValues xgcv;
2739 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2740 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2741 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2742 s->width, h);
2743 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2744 }
2745 }
2746
2747 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2748 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2749 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2750 }
2751
2752 /* Reset clipping. */
2753 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2754 }
2755
2756 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2757
2758 void
2759 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2760 struct frame *f;
2761 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2762 {
2763 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2764 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2765 x, y, width, height,
2766 x + shift_by, y);
2767 }
2768
2769 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2770 for X frames. */
2771
2772 static void
2773 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2774 register int n;
2775 {
2776 abort ();
2777 }
2778
2779
2780 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2781 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2782
2783 void
2784 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2785 Display *dpy;
2786 Window window;
2787 int x, y;
2788 int width, height;
2789 int exposures;
2790 {
2791 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2792 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2793 }
2794
2795
2796 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2797 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2798
2799 static void
2800 x_clear_frame ()
2801 {
2802 struct frame *f;
2803
2804 if (updating_frame)
2805 f = updating_frame;
2806 else
2807 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2808
2809 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2810 longer visible. */
2811 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2812 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2813 output_cursor.x = -1;
2814
2815 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2816 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2817 BLOCK_INPUT;
2818 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2819
2820 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2821 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2822 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2823
2824 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2825
2826 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2827 }
2828
2829
2830 \f
2831 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2832
2833 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2834 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2835
2836 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2837
2838
2839 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2840 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2841
2842 static int
2843 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2844 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2845 {
2846 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2847 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2848 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2849 {
2850 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2851 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2852 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2853 }
2854
2855 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2856 {
2857 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2858 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2859 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2860 }
2861
2862 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2863 positive. */
2864 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2865 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2866
2867 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2868 negative. */
2869 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2870 }
2871
2872 void
2873 XTflash (f)
2874 struct frame *f;
2875 {
2876 BLOCK_INPUT;
2877
2878 {
2879 GC gc;
2880
2881 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2882 pixels into background pixels. */
2883 {
2884 XGCValues values;
2885
2886 values.function = GXxor;
2887 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2888 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2889
2890 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2892 }
2893
2894 {
2895 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2896 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2897 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2898 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2899 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2900 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2902
2903 int width;
2904
2905 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2906 edge it is next to. */
2907 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2908 {
2909 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2910 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2911 break;
2912
2913 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2914 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2915 break;
2916
2917 default:
2918 break;
2919 }
2920
2921 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2922
2923 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2924 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2925 {
2926 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2927 flash_left,
2928 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2929 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2930 width, flash_height);
2931 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2932 flash_left,
2933 (height - flash_height
2934 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2935 width, flash_height);
2936 }
2937 else
2938 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2939 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2940 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2941 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2942
2943 x_flush (f);
2944
2945 {
2946 struct timeval wakeup;
2947
2948 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2949
2950 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2951 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2952 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2953 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2954
2955 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2956 available. */
2957 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2958 {
2959 struct timeval current;
2960 struct timeval timeout;
2961
2962 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2963
2964 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2965 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2966 break;
2967
2968 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2969 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2970 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2971
2972 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2973 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2974 }
2975 }
2976
2977 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2978 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2979 {
2980 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2981 flash_left,
2982 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2983 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2984 width, flash_height);
2985 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2986 flash_left,
2987 (height - flash_height
2988 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2989 width, flash_height);
2990 }
2991 else
2992 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2993 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2994 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2995 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2996
2997 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2998 x_flush (f);
2999 }
3000 }
3001
3002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3003 }
3004
3005 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3006
3007
3008 /* Make audible bell. */
3009
3010 void
3011 XTring_bell ()
3012 {
3013 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3014
3015 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3016 {
3017 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3018 if (visible_bell)
3019 XTflash (f);
3020 else
3021 #endif
3022 {
3023 BLOCK_INPUT;
3024 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3025 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3027 }
3028 }
3029 }
3030
3031 \f
3032 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3033 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3034 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3035 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3036
3037 static void
3038 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3039 register int n;
3040 {
3041 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3042 }
3043
3044
3045 \f
3046 /***********************************************************************
3047 Line Dance
3048 ***********************************************************************/
3049
3050 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3051 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3052
3053 static void
3054 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3055 int vpos, n;
3056 {
3057 abort ();
3058 }
3059
3060
3061 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3062
3063 static void
3064 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3065 struct window *w;
3066 struct run *run;
3067 {
3068 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3069 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3070
3071 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3072 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3073 fringe of W. */
3074 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3075
3076 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3077 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3078 bottom_y = y + height;
3079
3080 if (to_y < from_y)
3081 {
3082 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3083 line at the bottom. */
3084 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3085 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3086 else
3087 height = run->height;
3088 }
3089 else
3090 {
3091 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3092 at the bottom. */
3093 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3094 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3095 else
3096 height = run->height;
3097 }
3098
3099 BLOCK_INPUT;
3100
3101 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3102 updated_window = w;
3103 x_clear_cursor (w);
3104
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3106 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3107 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3108 x, from_y,
3109 width, height,
3110 x, to_y);
3111
3112 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3113 }
3114
3115
3116 \f
3117 /***********************************************************************
3118 Exposure Events
3119 ***********************************************************************/
3120
3121 \f
3122 static void
3123 frame_highlight (f)
3124 struct frame *f;
3125 {
3126 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3127 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3128 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3129 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3130 BLOCK_INPUT;
3131 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3132 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3133 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3134 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3135 }
3136
3137 static void
3138 frame_unhighlight (f)
3139 struct frame *f;
3140 {
3141 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3142 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3143 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3144 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3145 BLOCK_INPUT;
3146 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3147 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3148 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3149 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3150 }
3151
3152 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3153 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3154 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3155 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3156 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3157
3158 static void
3159 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3160 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3161 struct frame *frame;
3162 {
3163 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3164
3165 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3166 {
3167 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3168 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3169 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3170
3171 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3172 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3173
3174 #if 0
3175 selected_frame = frame;
3176 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3177 selected_frame);
3178 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3179 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3180 #endif /* ! 0 */
3181
3182 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3183 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3184 else
3185 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3186 }
3187
3188 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3189 }
3190
3191 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3192 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3193 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3194
3195 static void
3196 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3197 int type;
3198 int state;
3199 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3200 struct frame *frame;
3201 struct input_event *bufp;
3202 {
3203 if (type == FocusIn)
3204 {
3205 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3206 {
3207 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3208 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3209
3210 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3211 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3212 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3213 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3214 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3215 {
3216 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3217 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3218 }
3219 }
3220
3221 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3222
3223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3224 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3225 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3226 #endif
3227 }
3228 else if (type == FocusOut)
3229 {
3230 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3231
3232 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3233 {
3234 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3235 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3236 }
3237
3238 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3239 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3240 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3241 #endif
3242 }
3243 }
3244
3245 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3246 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3247
3248 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3249
3250 static void
3251 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3252 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3253 XEvent *event;
3254 struct input_event *bufp;
3255 {
3256 struct frame *frame;
3257
3258 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3259 if (! frame)
3260 return;
3261
3262 switch (event->type)
3263 {
3264 case EnterNotify:
3265 case LeaveNotify:
3266 {
3267 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3268 int focus_state
3269 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3270
3271 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3272 && event->xcrossing.focus
3273 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3274 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3275 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3276 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3277 }
3278 break;
3279
3280 case FocusIn:
3281 case FocusOut:
3282 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3283 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3284 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3285 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3286 break;
3287 }
3288 }
3289
3290
3291 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3292
3293 void
3294 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3296 {
3297 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3298 }
3299
3300 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3301 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3302 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3303
3304 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3305 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3306 the appropriate X display info. */
3307
3308 static void
3309 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3310 struct frame *frame;
3311 {
3312 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3313 }
3314
3315 static void
3316 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3318 {
3319 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3320
3321 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3322 {
3323 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3324 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3325 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3326 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3327 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3328 {
3329 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3330 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3331 }
3332 }
3333 else
3334 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3335
3336 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3337 {
3338 if (old_highlight)
3339 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3340 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3341 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3342 }
3343 }
3344
3345
3346 \f
3347 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3348
3349 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3350 static void
3351 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3352 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3353 {
3354 int min_code, max_code;
3355 KeySym *syms;
3356 int syms_per_code;
3357 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3358
3359 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3363 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3364
3365 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3366 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3367 #else
3368 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3369 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3370 #endif
3371
3372 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3373 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3374 &syms_per_code);
3375 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3376
3377 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3378 Alt keysyms are on. */
3379 {
3380 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3381 int found_alt_or_meta;
3382
3383 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3384 {
3385 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3386 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3387 {
3388 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3389
3390 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3391 if (code == 0)
3392 continue;
3393
3394 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3395 {
3396 int code_col;
3397
3398 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3399 {
3400 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3401
3402 switch (sym)
3403 {
3404 case XK_Meta_L:
3405 case XK_Meta_R:
3406 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3407 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3408 break;
3409
3410 case XK_Alt_L:
3411 case XK_Alt_R:
3412 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3414 break;
3415
3416 case XK_Hyper_L:
3417 case XK_Hyper_R:
3418 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3419 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3420 code_col = syms_per_code;
3421 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3422 break;
3423
3424 case XK_Super_L:
3425 case XK_Super_R:
3426 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3427 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3428 code_col = syms_per_code;
3429 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3430 break;
3431
3432 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3433 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3434 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3435 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3436 code_col = syms_per_code;
3437 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3438 break;
3439 }
3440 }
3441 }
3442 }
3443 }
3444 }
3445
3446 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3447 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3448 {
3449 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3450 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3451 }
3452
3453 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3454 make them just meta, not alt. */
3455 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3456 {
3457 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3458 }
3459
3460 XFree ((char *) syms);
3461 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3462 }
3463
3464 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3465 Emacs uses. */
3466
3467 static unsigned int
3468 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3469 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3470 unsigned int state;
3471 {
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3475 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3476 Lisp_Object tem;
3477
3478 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3479 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3480 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3481 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3482 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3484 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3486
3487
3488 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3493 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3494 }
3495
3496 static unsigned int
3497 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3498 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3499 unsigned int state;
3500 {
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3505
3506 Lisp_Object tem;
3507
3508 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3509 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3516
3517
3518 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3521 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3523 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3524 }
3525
3526 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3527
3528 char *
3529 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3530 KeySym keysym;
3531 {
3532 char *value;
3533
3534 BLOCK_INPUT;
3535 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3536 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3537
3538 return value;
3539 }
3540
3541
3542 \f
3543 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3544
3545 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3546
3547 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3548 the mouse. */
3549
3550 static Lisp_Object
3551 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3552 struct input_event *result;
3553 XButtonEvent *event;
3554 struct frame *f;
3555 {
3556 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3557 otherwise. */
3558 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3559 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3560 result->timestamp = event->time;
3561 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3562 event->state)
3563 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3564 ? up_modifier
3565 : down_modifier));
3566
3567 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3568 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3569 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3570 result->arg = Qnil;
3571 return Qnil;
3572 }
3573
3574 \f
3575 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3576 The input handler calls this.
3577
3578 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3579 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3580 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3581 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3582
3583 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3584 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3585
3586 static void
3587 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3588 FRAME_PTR frame;
3589 XMotionEvent *event;
3590 {
3591 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3592 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3593 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3594
3595 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3596 {
3597 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3598 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3599 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3600 }
3601
3602 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3603 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3604 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3605 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3606 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3607 {
3608 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3609 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3610 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3611 }
3612 }
3613
3614 \f
3615 /************************************************************************
3616 Mouse Face
3617 ************************************************************************/
3618
3619 static void
3620 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3621 {
3622 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3623 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3624 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3625 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3626 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3627 }
3628
3629
3630 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3631
3632
3633 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3634 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3635 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3636 values. */
3637
3638 static int
3639 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3640 struct frame *f;
3641 int x, y;
3642 XRectangle *rect;
3643 {
3644 Lisp_Object window;
3645 struct window *w;
3646 struct glyph_row *r, *end_row;
3647
3648 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3649 if (NILP (window))
3650 return 0;
3651
3652 w = XWINDOW (window);
3653 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3654 end_row = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3655
3656 for (; r < end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3657 {
3658 if (r->y >= y)
3659 {
3660 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3661 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3662 int gx = r->x;
3663 while (g < end && gx < x)
3664 gx += g->pixel_width, ++g;
3665 if (g < end)
3666 {
3667 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3668 rect->height = r->height;
3669 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3670 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3671 return 1;
3672 }
3673 break;
3674 }
3675 }
3676
3677 return 0;
3678 }
3679
3680
3681 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3682 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3683
3684 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3685 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3686 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3687 position on the scroll bar.
3688
3689 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3690 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3691 the mouse is over.
3692
3693 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3694 was at this position.
3695
3696 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3697
3698 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3699 movement. */
3700
3701 static void
3702 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3703 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3704 int insist;
3705 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3706 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3707 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3708 unsigned long *time;
3709 {
3710 FRAME_PTR f1;
3711
3712 BLOCK_INPUT;
3713
3714 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3715 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3716 else
3717 {
3718 Window root;
3719 int root_x, root_y;
3720
3721 Window dummy_window;
3722 int dummy;
3723
3724 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3725
3726 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3727 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3728 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3729 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3730
3731 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3732
3733 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3734 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3735 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3736
3737 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3738 &root,
3739
3740 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3741 a different screen. */
3742 &dummy_window,
3743
3744 /* The position on that root window. */
3745 &root_x, &root_y,
3746
3747 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3748 &dummy, &dummy,
3749
3750 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3751 we don't care. */
3752 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3753
3754 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3755 containing the pointer. */
3756 {
3757 Window win, child;
3758 int win_x, win_y;
3759 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3760 int count;
3761
3762 win = root;
3763
3764 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3765 structure is changing at the same time this function
3766 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3767
3768 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3769
3770 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3771 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3772 {
3773 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3774 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3775 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3776
3777 /* From-window, to-window. */
3778 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3779
3780 /* From-position, to-position. */
3781 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3782
3783 /* Child of win. */
3784 &child);
3785 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3786 }
3787 else
3788 {
3789 while (1)
3790 {
3791 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3792
3793 /* From-window, to-window. */
3794 root, win,
3795
3796 /* From-position, to-position. */
3797 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3798
3799 /* Child of win. */
3800 &child);
3801
3802 if (child == None || child == win)
3803 break;
3804
3805 win = child;
3806 parent_x = win_x;
3807 parent_y = win_y;
3808 }
3809
3810 /* Now we know that:
3811 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3812 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3813 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3814 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3815 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3816 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3817 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3818 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3819 never use them in that case.) */
3820
3821 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3822 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3823
3824 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3825 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3826 on the frame. */
3827 if (f1 != NULL
3828 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3829 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3830 f1 = NULL;
3831 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3832 }
3833
3834 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3835 f1 = 0;
3836
3837 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3838
3839 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3840 if (! f1)
3841 {
3842 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3843
3844 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3845
3846 if (bar)
3847 {
3848 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3849 win_x = parent_x;
3850 win_y = parent_y;
3851 }
3852 }
3853
3854 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3855 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3856
3857 if (f1)
3858 {
3859 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3860 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3861 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3862 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3863 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3864 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3865 the frame are divided into. */
3866
3867 int width, height, gx, gy;
3868 XRectangle rect;
3869
3870 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3871 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3872 else
3873 {
3874 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3875 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3876 gx = win_x;
3877 gy = win_y;
3878
3879 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3880 round down even for negative values. */
3881 if (gx < 0)
3882 gx -= width - 1;
3883 if (gy < 0)
3884 gy -= height - 1;
3885 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3886 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3887
3888 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3889 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3890 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3891 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3892 }
3893
3894 *bar_window = Qnil;
3895 *part = 0;
3896 *fp = f1;
3897 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3898 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3899 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3900 }
3901 }
3902 }
3903
3904 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3905 }
3906
3907
3908 \f
3909 /***********************************************************************
3910 Scroll bars
3911 ***********************************************************************/
3912
3913 /* Scroll bar support. */
3914
3915 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3916 manages it.
3917 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3918 bits. */
3919
3920 static struct scroll_bar *
3921 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3922 Display *display;
3923 Window window_id;
3924 {
3925 Lisp_Object tail;
3926
3927 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3928 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3929 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3930
3931 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3932 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3933 tail = XCDR (tail))
3934 {
3935 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3936
3937 frame = XCAR (tail);
3938 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3939 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3940 abort ();
3941
3942 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3943 right window ID. */
3944 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3945 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3946 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3947 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3948 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3949 condemned = Qnil,
3950 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3951 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3952 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3953 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3954 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3955 }
3956
3957 return 0;
3958 }
3959
3960
3961 #if defined USE_LUCID
3962
3963 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3964 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3965
3966 static Widget
3967 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3968 Window window;
3969 {
3970 Lisp_Object tail;
3971
3972 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3973 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3974 tail = XCDR (tail))
3975 {
3976 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3977 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3978
3979 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3980 return menu_bar;
3981 }
3982
3983 return NULL;
3984 }
3985
3986 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3987
3988 \f
3989 /************************************************************************
3990 Toolkit scroll bars
3991 ************************************************************************/
3992
3993 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3994
3995 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3996 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3997 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3998 struct scroll_bar *));
3999 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4000 int, int, int));
4001
4002
4003 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4004 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4005
4006 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4007
4008 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4009
4010 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4011
4012 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4013 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4014
4015 #ifndef USE_GTK
4016 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4017
4018 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4019
4020 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4021
4022 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4023 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4024 to avoid jerkyness. */
4025
4026 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4027
4028 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
4029
4030 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4031 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4032 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4033 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4034
4035 static void
4036 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4037 num_params)
4038 Widget widget;
4039 XtPointer client_data;
4040 String action_name;
4041 XEvent *event;
4042 String *params;
4043 Cardinal *num_params;
4044 {
4045 int scroll_bar_p;
4046 char *end_action;
4047
4048 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4049 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4050 end_action = "Release";
4051 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4052 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4053 end_action = "EndScroll";
4054 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4055
4056 if (scroll_bar_p
4057 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4058 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4059 {
4060 struct window *w;
4061
4062 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4063 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4064 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4065
4066 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4067 {
4068 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4069 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4070 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4071 }
4072 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4073 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4074
4075 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4076 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4077 }
4078 }
4079 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4080
4081 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4082 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4083
4084 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4085 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4086
4087
4088 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4089 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4090 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4091 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4092
4093 static void
4094 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4095 Lisp_Object window;
4096 int part, portion, whole;
4097 {
4098 XEvent event;
4099 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4100 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4101 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4102 int i;
4103
4104 BLOCK_INPUT;
4105
4106 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4107 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4108 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4109 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4110 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4111 ev->format = 32;
4112
4113 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4114 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4115 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4116 into that array in the event. */
4117 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4118 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4119 break;
4120
4121 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4122 {
4123 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4124 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4125 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4126
4127 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4128 nbytes);
4129 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4130 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4131 }
4132
4133 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4134 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4135 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4136 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4137 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4138 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4139
4140 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4141 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4142
4143 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4144 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4145 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4146 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4148 }
4149
4150
4151 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4152 in *IEVENT. */
4153
4154 static void
4155 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4156 XEvent *event;
4157 struct input_event *ievent;
4158 {
4159 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4160 Lisp_Object window;
4161 struct frame *f;
4162 struct window *w;
4163
4164 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4165 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4166
4167 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4168 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4169
4170 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4171 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4172 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4173 #ifdef USE_GTK
4174 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4175 #else
4176 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4177 #endif
4178 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4179 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4180 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4181 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4182 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4183 }
4184
4185
4186 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4187
4188 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4189
4190 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4191
4192
4193 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4194 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4195 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4196
4197 static void
4198 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4199 Widget widget;
4200 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4201 {
4202 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4203 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4204 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4205
4206 switch (cs->reason)
4207 {
4208 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4209 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4210 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4211 break;
4212
4213 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4214 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4215 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4216 break;
4217
4218 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4219 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4220 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4221 break;
4222
4223 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4224 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4225 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4226 break;
4227
4228 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4229 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4230 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4231 break;
4232
4233 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4234 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4235 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4236 break;
4237
4238 case XmCR_DRAG:
4239 {
4240 int slider_size;
4241
4242 /* Get the slider size. */
4243 BLOCK_INPUT;
4244 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4245 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4246
4247 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4248 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4249 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4250 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4251 }
4252 break;
4253
4254 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4255 break;
4256 };
4257
4258 if (part >= 0)
4259 {
4260 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4261 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4262 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4263 }
4264 }
4265
4266
4267 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4268 #ifdef USE_GTK
4269 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4270 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4271
4272 static void
4273 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4274 GtkRange *widget;
4275 gpointer data;
4276 {
4277 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4278 gdouble previous;
4279 gdouble position;
4280 gdouble *p;
4281 int diff;
4282
4283 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4284 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4285
4286 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4287
4288 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4289 if (! p)
4290 {
4291 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4292 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4293 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4294 }
4295
4296 previous = *p;
4297 *p = position;
4298
4299 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4300
4301 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4302
4303 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4304 {
4305 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4306 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4307 }
4308 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4309 {
4310 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4311 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4312 }
4313 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4314 {
4315 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4316 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4317 }
4318 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4319 {
4320 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4321 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4322 }
4323 else
4324 {
4325 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4326 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4327 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4328 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4329 }
4330
4331 if (part >= 0)
4332 {
4333 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4334 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4335 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4336 }
4337 }
4338
4339 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4340
4341 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4342 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4343 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4344 the thumb is. */
4345
4346 static void
4347 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4348 Widget widget;
4349 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4350 {
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4353 float shown;
4354 int whole, portion, height;
4355 int part;
4356
4357 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4358 BLOCK_INPUT;
4359 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4361
4362 whole = 10000000;
4363 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4364
4365 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4366 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4367 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4368 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4369 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4370 bottom). */
4371 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4372 else
4373 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4374
4375 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4376 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4377 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4378 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4379 }
4380
4381
4382 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4383 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4384 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4385 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4386 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4387 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4388 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4389
4390 static void
4391 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4392 Widget widget;
4393 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4394 {
4395 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4396 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4397 int position = (long) call_data;
4398 Dimension height;
4399 int part;
4400
4401 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4402 BLOCK_INPUT;
4403 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4405
4406 if (abs (position) >= height)
4407 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4408
4409 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4410 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4411 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4412 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4413 else
4414 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4415
4416 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4417 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4418 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4419 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4420 }
4421
4422 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4423 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4424
4425 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4426
4427 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4428 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4429
4430 #ifdef USE_GTK
4431 static void
4432 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4433 struct frame *f;
4434 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4435 {
4436 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4437
4438 BLOCK_INPUT;
4439 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4440 scroll_bar_name);
4441 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4442 }
4443
4444 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4445
4446 static void
4447 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4448 struct frame *f;
4449 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4450 {
4451 Window xwindow;
4452 Widget widget;
4453 Arg av[20];
4454 int ac = 0;
4455 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4456 unsigned long pixel;
4457
4458 BLOCK_INPUT;
4459
4460 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4461 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4462 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4463 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4464 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4465 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4468 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4469
4470 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4471 if (pixel != -1)
4472 {
4473 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4474 ++ac;
4475 }
4476
4477 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4478 if (pixel != -1)
4479 {
4480 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4481 ++ac;
4482 }
4483
4484 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4485 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4486
4487 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4488 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4489 (XtPointer) bar);
4490 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4491 (XtPointer) bar);
4492 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4493 (XtPointer) bar);
4494 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4495 (XtPointer) bar);
4496 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4497 (XtPointer) bar);
4498 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4499 (XtPointer) bar);
4500 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4501 (XtPointer) bar);
4502
4503 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4504 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4505
4506 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4507 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4508 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4509 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4510
4511 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4512
4513 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4514 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4515 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4516 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4517 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4518 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4519 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4520 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4521
4522 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4523 if (pixel != -1)
4524 {
4525 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4526 ++ac;
4527 }
4528
4529 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4530 if (pixel != -1)
4531 {
4532 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4533 ++ac;
4534 }
4535
4536 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4537
4538 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4539 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4540 {
4541 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4542 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4543 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4544 pixel = -1;
4545 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4546 }
4547 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4548 {
4549 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4550 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4551 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4552 pixel = -1;
4553 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4554 }
4555
4556 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4557 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4558 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4559 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4560 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4561 {
4562 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4563 ++ac;
4564 }
4565 else
4566 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4567 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4568 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4569 {
4570 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4571 the shadows. */
4572 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4573 ++ac;
4574
4575 /* Specify the colors. */
4576 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4577 if (pixel != -1)
4578 {
4579 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4580 ++ac;
4581 }
4582 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4583 if (pixel != -1)
4584 {
4585 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4586 ++ac;
4587 }
4588 }
4589
4590 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4591 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4592
4593 {
4594 char *initial = "";
4595 char *val = initial;
4596 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4597 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4598 if (val == initial)
4599 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4600 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4601 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4602 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4603 }
4604 }
4605
4606 /* Define callbacks. */
4607 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4608 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4609 (XtPointer) bar);
4610
4611 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4612 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4613
4614 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4615
4616 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4617 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4618 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4619 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4620
4621 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4622 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4623 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4624 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4625
4626 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4627 }
4628 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4629
4630
4631 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4632 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4633
4634 #ifdef USE_GTK
4635 static void
4636 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4637 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4638 int portion, position, whole;
4639 {
4640 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4641 }
4642
4643 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4644 static void
4645 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4646 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4647 int portion, position, whole;
4648 {
4649 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4650 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4651 float top, shown;
4652
4653 BLOCK_INPUT;
4654
4655 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4656
4657 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4658 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4659 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4660 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4661 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4662 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4663 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4664 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4665 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4666 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4667 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4668 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4669 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4670 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4671 whole += portion;
4672
4673 if (whole <= 0)
4674 top = 0, shown = 1;
4675 else
4676 {
4677 top = (float) position / whole;
4678 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4679 }
4680
4681 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4682 {
4683 int size, value;
4684
4685 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4686 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4687 value. */
4688 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4689 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4690 size = max (size, 1);
4691
4692 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4693 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4694 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4695
4696 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4697 }
4698 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4699
4700 if (whole == 0)
4701 top = 0, shown = 1;
4702 else
4703 {
4704 top = (float) position / whole;
4705 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4706 }
4707
4708 {
4709 float old_top, old_shown;
4710 Dimension height;
4711 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4712 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4713 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4714 XtNheight, &height,
4715 NULL);
4716
4717 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4718 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4719 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4720 else
4721 top = old_top;
4722 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4723 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4724
4725 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4726 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4727 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4728 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4729 {
4730 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4731 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4732 else
4733 {
4734 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4735 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4736 int scroll_mode = 0;
4737
4738 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4739 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4740 {
4741 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4742 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4743 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4744 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4745 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4746 }
4747 #endif
4748 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4749 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4750 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4751
4752 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4753
4754 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4755 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4756 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4757 #endif
4758 }
4759 }
4760 }
4761 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4762
4763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4764 }
4765 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4766
4767 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4768
4769
4770 \f
4771 /************************************************************************
4772 Scroll bars, general
4773 ************************************************************************/
4774
4775 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4776 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4777 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4778 scroll bar. */
4779
4780 static struct scroll_bar *
4781 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4782 struct window *w;
4783 int top, left, width, height;
4784 {
4785 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4786 struct scroll_bar *bar
4787 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4788
4789 BLOCK_INPUT;
4790
4791 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4792 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4793 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4794 {
4795 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4796 unsigned long mask;
4797 Window window;
4798
4799 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4800 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4801 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4802
4803 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4804 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4805 | ExposureMask);
4806 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4807
4808 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4809
4810 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4811 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4812 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4813 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4814 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4815 left, top, width,
4816 window_box_height (w), False);
4817
4818 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4819 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4820 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4821 top,
4822 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4823 height,
4824 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4825 0,
4826 CopyFromParent,
4827 CopyFromParent,
4828 CopyFromParent,
4829 /* Attributes. */
4830 mask, &a);
4831 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4832 }
4833 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4834
4835 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4836 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4837 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4838 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4839 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4840 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4841 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4842 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4843
4844 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4845 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4846 bar->prev = Qnil;
4847 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4848 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4849 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4850
4851 /* Map the window/widget. */
4852 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4853 {
4854 #ifdef USE_GTK
4855 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4856 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4857 top,
4858 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4859 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4860 max (height, 1));
4861 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4862 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4863 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4864 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4865 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4866 top,
4867 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4868 max (height, 1), 0);
4869 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4870 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4871 }
4872 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4873 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4874 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4875
4876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4877 return bar;
4878 }
4879
4880
4881 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4882
4883 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4884 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4885 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4886 events.)
4887
4888 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4889 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4890 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4891 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4892 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4893
4894 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4895
4896 static void
4897 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4898 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4899 int start, end;
4900 int rebuild;
4901 {
4902 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4903 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4904 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4905 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4906
4907 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4908 if (! rebuild
4909 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4910 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4911 return;
4912
4913 BLOCK_INPUT;
4914
4915 {
4916 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4917 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4918 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4919
4920 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4921 the distance between start and end. */
4922 {
4923 int length = end - start;
4924
4925 if (start < 0)
4926 start = 0;
4927 else if (start > top_range)
4928 start = top_range;
4929 end = start + length;
4930
4931 if (end < start)
4932 end = start;
4933 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4934 end = top_range;
4935 }
4936
4937 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4938 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4939 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4940
4941 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4942 if (end > top_range)
4943 end = top_range;
4944
4945 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4946 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4947 that many pixels tall. */
4948 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4949
4950 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4951 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4952 if (0 < start)
4953 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4954 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4955 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4956 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4957 inside_width, start,
4958 False);
4959
4960 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4961 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4962 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4963 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4964
4965 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4966 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4967 /* x, y, width, height */
4968 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4969 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4970 inside_width, end - start);
4971
4972 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4973 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4974 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4975 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4976
4977 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4978 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4979 if (end < inside_height)
4980 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4981 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4982 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4983 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4984 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4985 False);
4986
4987 }
4988
4989 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4990 }
4991
4992 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4993
4994 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4995 nil. */
4996
4997 static void
4998 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4999 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5000 {
5001 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5002 BLOCK_INPUT;
5003
5004 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5005 #ifdef USE_GTK
5006 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5007 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5008 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5009 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5010 #else
5011 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5012 #endif
5013
5014 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5015 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5016
5017 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5018 }
5019
5020
5021 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5022 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5023 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5024 create one. */
5025
5026 static void
5027 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5028 struct window *w;
5029 int portion, whole, position;
5030 {
5031 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5032 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5033 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5034 int window_y, window_height;
5035
5036 /* Get window dimensions. */
5037 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5038 top = window_y;
5039 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5040 height = window_height;
5041
5042 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5043 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5044
5045 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5046 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5047 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5048 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5049 else
5050 sb_width = width;
5051
5052 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5053 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5054 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5055 sb_left = (left +
5056 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5057 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5058 : 0));
5059 else
5060 sb_left = (left +
5061 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5062 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5063 : width - sb_width));
5064 #else
5065 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5066 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5067 else
5068 sb_left = left;
5069 #endif
5070
5071 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5072 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5073 {
5074 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5075 {
5076 BLOCK_INPUT;
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, width, height, False);
5079 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5080 }
5081
5082 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5083 }
5084 else
5085 {
5086 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5087 unsigned int mask = 0;
5088
5089 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5090
5091 BLOCK_INPUT;
5092
5093 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5094 mask |= CWX;
5095 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5096 mask |= CWY;
5097 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5098 mask |= CWWidth;
5099 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5100 mask |= CWHeight;
5101
5102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5103
5104 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5105 if (mask)
5106 {
5107 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5108 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5109 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5110 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5111 left, top, width, height, False);
5112 #ifdef USE_GTK
5113 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5114 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5115 top,
5116 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5117 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5118 max (height, 1));
5119 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5120 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5121 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5122 top,
5123 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5124 max (height, 1), 0);
5125 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5126 }
5127 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5128
5129 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5130 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5131 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5132 {
5133 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5134 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5135 height, False);
5136 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5137 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5138 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5139 height, False);
5140 }
5141
5142 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5143 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5144 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5145 example. */
5146 {
5147 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5148 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5149 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5150 {
5151 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5152 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5153 left + area_width - rest, top,
5154 rest, height, False);
5155 else
5156 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5157 left, top, rest, height, False);
5158 }
5159 }
5160
5161 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5162 if (mask)
5163 {
5164 XWindowChanges wc;
5165
5166 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5167 wc.y = top;
5168 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5169 wc.height = height;
5170 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5171 mask, &wc);
5172 }
5173
5174 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5175
5176 /* Remember new settings. */
5177 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5178 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5179 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5180 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5181
5182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5183 }
5184
5185 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5186 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5187 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5188 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5189 dragged. */
5190 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5191 {
5192 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5193
5194 if (whole == 0)
5195 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5196 else
5197 {
5198 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5199 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5200 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5201 }
5202 }
5203 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5204
5205 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5206 }
5207
5208
5209 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5210 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5211 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5212 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5213 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5214 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5215 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5216
5217 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5218 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5219 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5220
5221 static void
5222 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5223 FRAME_PTR frame;
5224 {
5225 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5226 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5227 {
5228 Lisp_Object bar;
5229 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5230 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5231 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5232 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5233 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5234 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5235 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5236 }
5237 }
5238
5239
5240 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5241 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5242
5243 static void
5244 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5245 struct window *window;
5246 {
5247 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5248 struct frame *f;
5249
5250 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5251 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5252 abort ();
5253
5254 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5255
5256 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5257 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5258 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5259 {
5260 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5261 the lists. */
5262 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5263 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5264 return;
5265 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5266 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5267 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5268 else
5269 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5270 one or the other! */
5271 abort ();
5272 }
5273 else
5274 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5275
5276 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5277 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5278
5279 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5280 bar->prev = Qnil;
5281 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5282 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5283 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5284 }
5285
5286 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5287 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5288
5289 static void
5290 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5291 FRAME_PTR f;
5292 {
5293 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5294
5295 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5296
5297 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5298 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5299 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5300
5301 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5302 {
5303 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5304
5305 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5306
5307 next = b->next;
5308 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5309 }
5310
5311 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5312 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5313 }
5314
5315
5316 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5317 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5318 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5319
5320 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5321 mark bits. */
5322
5323 static void
5324 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5325 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5326 XEvent *event;
5327 {
5328 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5329 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5330 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5331 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5332
5333 BLOCK_INPUT;
5334
5335 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5336
5337 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5338 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5339
5340 /* x, y, width, height */
5341 0, 0,
5342 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5343 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5344
5345 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5346
5347 }
5348 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5349
5350 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5351 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5352
5353 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5354 mark bits. */
5355
5356
5357 static void
5358 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5359 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5360 XEvent *event;
5361 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5362 {
5363 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5364 abort ();
5365
5366 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5367 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5368 emacs_event->modifiers
5369 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5370 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5371 event->xbutton.state)
5372 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5373 ? up_modifier
5374 : down_modifier));
5375 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5376 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5377 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5378 {
5379 #if 0
5380 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5381 int internal_height
5382 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5383 #endif
5384 int top_range
5385 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5386 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5387
5388 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5389 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5390
5391 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5392 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5393 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5394 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5395 else
5396 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5397
5398 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5399 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5400 whether or not we're dragging. */
5401 #if 0
5402 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5403 holding it. */
5404 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5405 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5406 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5407 #endif
5408
5409 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5410 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5411 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5412 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5413 {
5414 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5415 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5416
5417 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5418 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5419 }
5420 #endif
5421
5422 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5423 #if 0
5424 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5425 the handle. */
5426 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5427 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5428 else
5429 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5430 #else
5431 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5432 #endif
5433
5434 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5435 }
5436 }
5437
5438 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5439
5440 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5441
5442 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5443 mark bits. */
5444
5445 static void
5446 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5447 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5448 XEvent *event;
5449 {
5450 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5451
5452 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5453
5454 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5455 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5456
5457 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5458 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5459 {
5460 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5461 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5462
5463 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5464 {
5465 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5466
5467 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5468 }
5469 }
5470 }
5471
5472 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5473
5474 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5475 on the scroll bar. */
5476
5477 static void
5478 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5479 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5480 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5481 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5482 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5483 unsigned long *time;
5484 {
5485 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5486 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5487 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5488 int win_x, win_y;
5489 Window dummy_window;
5490 int dummy_coord;
5491 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5492
5493 BLOCK_INPUT;
5494
5495 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5496 report that. */
5497 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5498
5499 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5500 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5501 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5502
5503 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5504 &win_x, &win_y,
5505
5506 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5507 &dummy_mask))
5508 ;
5509 else
5510 {
5511 #if 0
5512 int inside_height
5513 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5514 #endif
5515 int top_range
5516 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5517
5518 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5519
5520 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5521 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5522
5523 if (win_y < 0)
5524 win_y = 0;
5525 if (win_y > top_range)
5526 win_y = top_range;
5527
5528 *fp = f;
5529 *bar_window = bar->window;
5530
5531 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5532 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5533 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5534 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5535 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5536 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5537 else
5538 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5539
5540 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5541 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5542
5543 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5544 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5545 }
5546
5547 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5548
5549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5550 }
5551
5552
5553 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5554 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5555 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5556 redraw them. */
5557
5558 void
5559 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5560 FRAME_PTR f;
5561 {
5562 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5563 Lisp_Object bar;
5564
5565 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5566 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5567 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5568 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5569 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5570 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5571 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5572 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5573 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5574 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5575 }
5576
5577 \f
5578 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5579
5580 #if 0
5581 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5582 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5583 sometimes don't work. */
5584
5585 static Time enter_timestamp;
5586 #endif
5587
5588 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5589 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5590 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5591 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5592
5593 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5594 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5595
5596 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5597
5598 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5599 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5600
5601 static int temp_index;
5602 static short temp_buffer[100];
5603
5604 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5605 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5606 temp_index = 0; \
5607 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5608
5609 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5610 on a particular display. */
5611
5612 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5613
5614 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5615 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5616 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5617 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5618
5619 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5620
5621 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5622 do \
5623 { \
5624 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5625 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5626 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5627 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5628 inev.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5629 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f); \
5630 } \
5631 while (0)
5632
5633 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5634 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5635
5636
5637 enum
5638 {
5639 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5640 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5641 X_EVENT_DROP
5642 };
5643
5644 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5645 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5646 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5647
5648 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5649 this event further.
5650 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5651
5652 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5653 static int
5654 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5656 XEvent *event;
5657 {
5658 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5659 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5660 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5661 was created. */
5662
5663 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5664 event->xclient.window);
5665
5666 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5667 }
5668 #endif
5669
5670 #ifdef USE_GTK
5671 static int current_count;
5672 static int current_finish;
5673 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5674
5675 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5676 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5677 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5678 static GdkFilterReturn
5679 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5680 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5681 GdkEvent *ev;
5682 gpointer data;
5683 {
5684 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5685
5686 if (current_count >= 0)
5687 {
5688 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5689
5690 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5691
5692 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5693 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5694 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5695 so we do it here. */
5696 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5697 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5698 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5699 #endif
5700
5701 if (! dpyinfo)
5702 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5703 else
5704 {
5705 current_count +=
5706 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5707 current_hold_quit);
5708 }
5709 }
5710 else
5711 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5712
5713 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5714 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5715
5716 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5717 }
5718 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5719
5720
5721 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5722
5723 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5724 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5725 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5726
5727 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5728
5729 static int
5730 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5732 XEvent *eventp;
5733 int *finish;
5734 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5735 {
5736 struct input_event inev;
5737 int count = 0;
5738 int do_help = 0;
5739 int nbytes = 0;
5740 struct frame *f;
5741 struct coding_system coding;
5742 XEvent event = *eventp;
5743
5744 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5745
5746 EVENT_INIT (inev);
5747 inev.kind = NO_EVENT;
5748 inev.arg = Qnil;
5749
5750 switch (event.type)
5751 {
5752 case ClientMessage:
5753 {
5754 if (event.xclient.message_type
5755 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5756 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5757 {
5758 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5759 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5760 {
5761 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5762 could be the shell widget window
5763 if the frame has no title bar. */
5764 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5765 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5766 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5767 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5768 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5769 #endif
5770 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5771 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5772 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5773 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5774 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5775 needed.
5776
5777 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5778 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5779 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5780 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5781 Emacs. */
5782
5783 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5784 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5785 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5786 if (f)
5787 {
5788 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5789 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5790 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5791 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5792 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5793 /* The ICCCM says this is
5794 the only valid choice. */
5795 RevertToParent,
5796 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5797 /* This is needed to detect the error
5798 if there is an error. */
5799 XSync (d, False);
5800 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5801 }
5802 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5803 #endif /* 0 */
5804 goto done;
5805 }
5806
5807 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5808 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5809 {
5810 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5811 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5812 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5813 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5814 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5815 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5816 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5817 session manager and one for this. */
5818 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5819 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5820 #endif
5821 {
5822 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5823 event.xclient.window);
5824 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5825 for a single Emacs process. */
5826 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5827 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5828 event.xclient.window,
5829 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5830 else if (f)
5831 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5832 event.xclient.window,
5833 0, 0);
5834 }
5835 goto done;
5836 }
5837
5838 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5839 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5840 {
5841 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5842 event.xclient.window);
5843 if (!f)
5844 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5845
5846 inev.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5847 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
5848 goto done;
5849 }
5850
5851 goto done;
5852 }
5853
5854 if (event.xclient.message_type
5855 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5856 {
5857 goto done;
5858 }
5859
5860 if (event.xclient.message_type
5861 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5862 {
5863 int new_x, new_y;
5864 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5865
5866 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5867 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5868
5869 if (f)
5870 {
5871 f->left_pos = new_x;
5872 f->top_pos = new_y;
5873 }
5874 goto done;
5875 }
5876
5877 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5878 if (event.xclient.message_type
5879 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5880 {
5881 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5882 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5883 &event, NULL);
5884 goto done;
5885 }
5886 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5887
5888 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5889 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5890 || (event.xclient.message_type
5891 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5892 {
5893 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5894 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5895 currently never do because we are interested in
5896 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5897 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5898 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5899 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5900 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5901 goto done;
5902 }
5903
5904 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5905 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5906 we construct an input_event. */
5907 if (event.xclient.message_type
5908 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5909 {
5910 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev);
5911 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5912 goto done;
5913 }
5914 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5915
5916 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5917
5918 if (!f)
5919 goto OTHER;
5920
5921 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev))
5922 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5923 }
5924 break;
5925
5926 case SelectionNotify:
5927 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5928 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5929 goto OTHER;
5930 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5931 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5932 break;
5933
5934 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5935 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5936 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5937 goto OTHER;
5938 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5939 {
5940 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5941
5942 inev.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5943 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5944 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5945 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5946 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5947 }
5948 break;
5949
5950 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5951 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5952 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5953 goto OTHER;
5954 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5955 {
5956 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5957 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5958
5959 inev.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5960 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5961 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev) = eventp->requestor;
5962 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5963 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev) = eventp->target;
5964 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev) = eventp->property;
5965 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5966 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5967 }
5968 break;
5969
5970 case PropertyNotify:
5971 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5972 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5973 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5974 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5975 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5976 goto OTHER;
5977 #endif
5978 #endif
5979 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5980 goto OTHER;
5981
5982 case ReparentNotify:
5983 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5984 if (f)
5985 {
5986 int x, y;
5987 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5988 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5989 f->left_pos = x;
5990 f->top_pos = y;
5991
5992 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5993 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5994 }
5995 goto OTHER;
5996
5997 case Expose:
5998 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5999 if (f)
6000 {
6001 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6002
6003 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6004 {
6005 f->async_visible = 1;
6006 f->async_iconified = 0;
6007 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6008 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6009 }
6010 else
6011 expose_frame (f,
6012 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6013 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6014 }
6015 else
6016 {
6017 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6018 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6019 #endif
6020 #if defined USE_LUCID
6021 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6022 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6023 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6024 {
6025 Widget widget
6026 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6027 if (widget)
6028 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6029 }
6030 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6031
6032 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6033 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6034 goto OTHER;
6035 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6036 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6037 event.xexpose.window);
6038
6039 if (bar)
6040 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6041 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6042 else
6043 goto OTHER;
6044 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6045 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6046 }
6047 break;
6048
6049 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6050 source area was obscured or not
6051 available. */
6052 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6053 if (f)
6054 {
6055 expose_frame (f,
6056 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6057 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6058 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6059 }
6060 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6061 else
6062 goto OTHER;
6063 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6064 break;
6065
6066 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6067 source area was completely
6068 available. */
6069 break;
6070
6071 case UnmapNotify:
6072 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6073 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6074 {
6075 tip_window = 0;
6076 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6077 }
6078
6079 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6080 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6081 the frame was deleted. */
6082 {
6083 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6084 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6085 display that won't ever be seen. */
6086 f->async_visible = 0;
6087 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6088 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6089 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6090 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6091 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6092 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6093 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6094 {
6095 f->async_iconified = 1;
6096
6097 inev.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6098 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6099 }
6100 }
6101 goto OTHER;
6102
6103 case MapNotify:
6104 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6105 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6106 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6107 goto OTHER;
6108
6109 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6110 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6111 frame is visible. */
6112 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6113 if (f)
6114 {
6115 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6116 the frame's display structures.
6117 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6118 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6119 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6120 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6121 if (! f->async_iconified)
6122 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6123
6124 f->async_visible = 1;
6125 f->async_iconified = 0;
6126 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6127
6128 if (f->iconified)
6129 {
6130 inev.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6131 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6132 }
6133 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6134 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6135 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6136 to update the frame titles
6137 in case this is the second frame. */
6138 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6139 }
6140 goto OTHER;
6141
6142 case KeyPress:
6143
6144 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6145
6146 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6147 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6148 if (popup_activated ())
6149 goto OTHER;
6150 #endif
6151
6152 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6153
6154 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6155 {
6156 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6157 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6158 }
6159
6160 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6161 if (f == 0)
6162 {
6163 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6164 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6165 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6166 event.xkey.window);
6167 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6168 {
6169 widget = XtParent (widget);
6170 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6171 }
6172 }
6173 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6174
6175 if (f != 0)
6176 {
6177 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6178 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6179 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6180 his Emacs hang.
6181
6182 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6183 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6184 status_return even if the input is too long to
6185 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6186 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6187 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6188 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6189 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6190 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6191 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6192 int modifiers;
6193 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6194 Lisp_Object c;
6195
6196 #ifdef USE_GTK
6197 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6198 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6199 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6200 (see above). */
6201 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6202 #endif
6203
6204 event.xkey.state
6205 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6206 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6207 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6208
6209 /* This will have to go some day... */
6210
6211 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6212 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6213 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6214 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6215 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6216 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6217 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6218
6219 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6220 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6221 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6222 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6223 not it is combined with Meta. */
6224 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6225 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6226
6227 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6228 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6229 {
6230 Status status_return;
6231
6232 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6233 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6234 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6235 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6236 &status_return);
6237 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6238 {
6239 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6240 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6241 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6242 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6243 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6244 &status_return);
6245 }
6246 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6247 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6248 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6249 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6250 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6251 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6252 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6253 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6254 &status_return);
6255 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6256 {
6257 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6258 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6259 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6260 &event.xkey,
6261 copy_bufptr,
6262 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6263 &status_return);
6264 }
6265 }
6266 #endif
6267
6268 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6269 break;
6270 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6271 {
6272 keysym = NoSymbol;
6273 modifiers = 0;
6274 }
6275 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6276 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6277 abort ();
6278 }
6279 else
6280 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6281 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6282 &compose_status);
6283 #else
6284 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6285 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6286 &compose_status);
6287 #endif
6288
6289 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6290 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6291 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6292 break;
6293
6294 orig_keysym = keysym;
6295
6296 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6297 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6298 inev.modifiers
6299 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6300 inev.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6301
6302 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6303 translations to characters. */
6304 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6305 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6306 {
6307 inev.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6308 inev.code = keysym;
6309 goto done_keysym;
6310 }
6311
6312 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6313 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6314 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6315 Vx_keysym_table,
6316 Qnil))))
6317 {
6318 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6319 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6320 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6321 inev.code = XFASTINT (c);
6322 goto done_keysym;
6323 }
6324
6325 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6326 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6327 || keysym == XK_Delete
6328 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6329 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6330 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6331 #endif
6332 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6333 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6334 #ifdef HPUX
6335 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6336 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6337 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6338 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6339 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6340 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6341 #endif
6342 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6343 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6344 #endif
6345 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6346 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6347 #endif
6348 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6349 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6350 #endif
6351 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6352 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6353 #endif
6354 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6355 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6356 #endif
6357 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6358 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6359 #endif
6360 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6361 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6362 #endif
6363 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6364 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6365 #endif
6366 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6367 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6368 #endif
6369 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6370 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6371 #endif
6372 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6373 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6374 #endif
6375 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6376 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6377 #endif
6378 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6379 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6380 #endif
6381 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6382 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6383 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6384 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6385 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6386 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6387 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6388 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6389 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6390 #endif
6391 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6392 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6393 #endif
6394 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6395 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6396 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6397 don't have real modifiers but
6398 should be treated similarly to
6399 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6400 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6401 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6402 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6403 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6404 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6405 #endif
6406 ))
6407 {
6408 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6409 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6410 key. */
6411 inev.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6412 inev.code = keysym;
6413 goto done_keysym;
6414 }
6415
6416 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6417 register int i;
6418 register int c;
6419 int nchars, len;
6420
6421 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6422 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6423 we used just above and the locale. */
6424 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6425 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6426 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6427 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6428 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6429 gives us composition information. */
6430 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6431
6432 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6433 {
6434 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6435 }
6436
6437 {
6438 /* Decode the input data. */
6439 int require;
6440 unsigned char *p;
6441
6442 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6443 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6444 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6445 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6446 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6447 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6448 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6449 nbytes = coding.produced;
6450 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6451 copy_bufptr = p;
6452 }
6453
6454 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6455 character events. */
6456 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6457 {
6458 if (nchars == nbytes)
6459 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6460 else
6461 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6462 nbytes - i, len);
6463 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6464 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6465 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6466 inev.code = c;
6467 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6468 }
6469
6470 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6471 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6472 count += nbytes;
6473
6474 inev.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6475
6476 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6477 break;
6478 }
6479 }
6480 done_keysym:
6481 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6482 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6483 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6484 client. */
6485 break;
6486 #else
6487 goto OTHER;
6488 #endif
6489
6490 case KeyRelease:
6491 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6492 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6493 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6494 client. */
6495 break;
6496 #else
6497 goto OTHER;
6498 #endif
6499
6500 case EnterNotify:
6501 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6502
6503 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6504
6505 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6506 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6507
6508 #if 0
6509 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6510 {
6511 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6512 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6513 || !(f->auto_lower)
6514 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6515 {
6516 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6517 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6518 }
6519 }
6520 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6521 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6522 #endif
6523
6524 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6525 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6526 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6527 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6528 goto OTHER;
6529
6530 case FocusIn:
6531 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6532 goto OTHER;
6533
6534 case LeaveNotify:
6535 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6536
6537 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6538 if (f)
6539 {
6540 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6541 {
6542 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6543 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6544 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6545 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6546 }
6547
6548 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6549 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6550 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6551 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6552 if (any_help_event_p)
6553 do_help = -1;
6554 }
6555 goto OTHER;
6556
6557 case FocusOut:
6558 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6559 goto OTHER;
6560
6561 case MotionNotify:
6562 {
6563 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6564 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6565 help_echo_pos = -1;
6566
6567 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6568 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6569 f = last_mouse_frame;
6570 else
6571 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6572
6573 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6574 {
6575 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6576 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6577 }
6578
6579 if (f)
6580 {
6581
6582 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6583 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6584 {
6585 Lisp_Object window;
6586
6587 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6588 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6589 0, 0, 0, 0);
6590
6591 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6592 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6593 will be selected iff it is active. */
6594 if (WINDOWP (window)
6595 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6596 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6597 {
6598 inev.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6599 inev.frame_or_window = window;
6600 }
6601
6602 last_window=window;
6603 }
6604 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6605 }
6606 else
6607 {
6608 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6609 struct scroll_bar *bar
6610 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6611 event.xmotion.window);
6612
6613 if (bar)
6614 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6615 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6616
6617 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6618 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6619 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6620 }
6621
6622 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6623 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6624 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6625 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6626 do_help = 1;
6627 goto OTHER;
6628 }
6629
6630 case ConfigureNotify:
6631 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6632 if (f)
6633 {
6634 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6635 #ifdef USE_GTK
6636 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6637 event.xconfigure.height);
6638 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6639 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6640 do this one, the right one will come later.
6641 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6642 need to reset it below. */
6643 int dont_resize
6644 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6645 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6646 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6647 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6648
6649 if (dont_resize)
6650 goto OTHER;
6651
6652 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6653 is called by the code that handles resizing
6654 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6655
6656 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6657 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6658 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6659 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6660 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6661 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6662 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6663 {
6664 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6665 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6666 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6667 }
6668 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6669 #endif
6670
6671 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6672 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6673
6674 #ifdef USE_GTK
6675 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6676 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6677 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6678 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6679 #endif
6680 {
6681 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6682 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6683 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6684
6685 x_check_expected_move (f);
6686 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6687 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6688 }
6689
6690 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6691 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6692 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6693 #endif
6694
6695 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6696 {
6697 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6698 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6699 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6700 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6701 }
6702 }
6703 goto OTHER;
6704
6705 case ButtonRelease:
6706 case ButtonPress:
6707 {
6708 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6709 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6710 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6711
6712 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6713
6714 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6715 && last_mouse_frame
6716 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6717 f = last_mouse_frame;
6718 else
6719 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6720
6721 if (f)
6722 {
6723 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6724 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6725 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6726 {
6727 Lisp_Object window;
6728 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6729 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6730
6731 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6732 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6733 {
6734 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6735 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6736 else
6737 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6738 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6739 event.xbutton.state));
6740 tool_bar_p = 1;
6741 }
6742 }
6743
6744 if (!tool_bar_p)
6745 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6746 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6747 {
6748 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6749 if (! popup_activated ())
6750 #endif
6751 {
6752 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6753 {
6754 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6755 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6756 {
6757 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6758 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6759 }
6760 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6761 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6762 }
6763 else
6764 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6765 }
6766 }
6767 }
6768 else
6769 {
6770 struct scroll_bar *bar
6771 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6772 event.xbutton.window);
6773
6774 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6775 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6776 scroll bars. */
6777 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6778 {
6779 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6780 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6781 }
6782 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6783 if (bar)
6784 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6785 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6786 }
6787
6788 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6789 {
6790 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6791 last_mouse_frame = f;
6792 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6793 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6794 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6795 the ButtonPress. */
6796 if (f != 0)
6797 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6798
6799 if (!tool_bar_p)
6800 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6801 }
6802 else
6803 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6804
6805 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6806 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6807 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6808 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6809 Instead, save it away
6810 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6811 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6812 if (
6813 #ifdef USE_GTK
6814 ! popup_activated ()
6815 &&
6816 #endif
6817 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6818 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6819 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6820 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6821 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6822 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6823 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6824 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6825 {
6826 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6827 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6828 #ifdef USE_GTK
6829 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6830 #endif
6831 }
6832 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6833 {
6834 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6835 goto OTHER;
6836 }
6837
6838 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6839 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6840 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6841 {
6842 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6843 {
6844 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6845 if (f->output_data.x)
6846 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6847 }
6848 else
6849 goto OTHER;
6850 }
6851 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6852 else
6853 goto OTHER;
6854 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6855 }
6856 break;
6857
6858 case CirculateNotify:
6859 goto OTHER;
6860
6861 case CirculateRequest:
6862 goto OTHER;
6863
6864 case VisibilityNotify:
6865 goto OTHER;
6866
6867 case MappingNotify:
6868 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6869 local cache. */
6870 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6871 {
6872 case MappingModifier:
6873 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6874 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6875 case MappingKeyboard:
6876 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6877 }
6878 goto OTHER;
6879
6880 default:
6881 OTHER:
6882 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6883 BLOCK_INPUT;
6884 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6885 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6886 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6887 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6888 break;
6889 }
6890
6891 done:
6892 if (inev.kind != NO_EVENT)
6893 {
6894 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6895 count++;
6896 }
6897
6898 if (do_help
6899 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6900 {
6901 Lisp_Object frame;
6902
6903 if (f)
6904 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6905 else
6906 frame = Qnil;
6907
6908 if (do_help > 0)
6909 {
6910 any_help_event_p = 1;
6911 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6912 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6913 }
6914 else
6915 {
6916 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6917 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6918 }
6919 count++;
6920 }
6921
6922 *eventp = event;
6923 return count;
6924 }
6925
6926
6927 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6928 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6929 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6930
6931 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6932 int
6933 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6934 XEvent *event;
6935 Display *display;
6936 {
6937 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6938 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6939
6940 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6941
6942 if (dpyinfo)
6943 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6944
6945 return finish;
6946 }
6947
6948
6949 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6950 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6951 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6952
6953 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6954 thus pretending to be `read'.
6955
6956 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6957
6958 static int
6959 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6960 register int sd;
6961 int expected;
6962 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6963 {
6964 int count = 0;
6965 XEvent event;
6966 int event_found = 0;
6967 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6968
6969 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6970 {
6971 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6972 return -1;
6973 }
6974
6975 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6976 BLOCK_INPUT;
6977
6978 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6979 input_signal_count++;
6980
6981 ++handling_signal;
6982
6983 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6984 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6985 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6986 {
6987 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6988 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6989 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6990 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6991 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6992 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6993 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6994 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6995 #endif
6996
6997 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6998 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6999 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7000 for X connections. */
7001 #ifndef SIGIO
7002 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7003 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7004 {
7005 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7006 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7007 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7008 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7009 }
7010 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7011 #endif /* SIGIO */
7012 #endif
7013
7014 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7015 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7016 {
7017 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7018 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7019 }
7020
7021 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7022 {
7023 struct input_event inev;
7024 BLOCK_INPUT;
7025 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7026 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7027 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7028 {
7029 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7030 count++;
7031 }
7032 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7033 }
7034 #endif
7035
7036 #ifndef USE_GTK
7037 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7038 {
7039 int finish;
7040
7041 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7042
7043 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7044 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7045 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7046 break;
7047 #endif
7048 event_found = 1;
7049
7050 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7051
7052 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7053 goto out;
7054 }
7055 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7056 }
7057
7058 #ifdef USE_GTK
7059
7060 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7061 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7062 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7063 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7064
7065 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7066 from all displays. */
7067
7068 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7069 {
7070 current_count = count;
7071 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7072
7073 gtk_main_iteration ();
7074
7075 count = current_count;
7076 current_count = -1;
7077 current_hold_quit = 0;
7078
7079 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7080 break;
7081 }
7082 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7083
7084 out:;
7085
7086 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7087 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7088 if (! event_found)
7089 {
7090 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7091 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7092 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7093 x_noop_count++;
7094 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7095 {
7096 x_noop_count=0;
7097
7098 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7099 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7100
7101 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7102
7103 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7104 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7105 }
7106 }
7107
7108 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7109 raise it now. */
7110 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7111 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7112 {
7113 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7114 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7115 }
7116
7117 --handling_signal;
7118 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7119
7120 return count;
7121 }
7122
7123
7124
7125 \f
7126 /***********************************************************************
7127 Text Cursor
7128 ***********************************************************************/
7129
7130 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7131 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7132
7133 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7134 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7135 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7136
7137 static void
7138 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7139 struct window *w;
7140 struct glyph_row *row;
7141 int area;
7142 GC gc;
7143 {
7144 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7145 XRectangle clip_rect;
7146 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7147
7148 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7149
7150 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7151 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7152 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7153 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7154 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7155
7156 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7157 }
7158
7159
7160 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7161
7162 static void
7163 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7164 struct window *w;
7165 struct glyph_row *row;
7166 {
7167 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7168 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7169 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7170 int x, y, wd, h;
7171 XGCValues xgcv;
7172 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7173 GC gc;
7174
7175 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7176 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7177 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7178 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7179 return;
7180
7181 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7182 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7183 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7184 width instead. */
7185 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7186 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7187 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7188 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7189 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7190
7191 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7192 coordinates. */
7193 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7194 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y);
7195
7196 /* Compute the proper height and ascent of the rectangle, based
7197 on the actual glyph. Using the full height of the row looks
7198 bad when there are tall images on that row. */
7199 h = max (min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->height),
7200 cursor_glyph->ascent + cursor_glyph->descent);
7201 if (h < row->height)
7202 y += row->ascent /* - w->phys_cursor_ascent */ + cursor_glyph->descent - h;
7203 h--;
7204
7205 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7206 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7207 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7208 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7209 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7210 else
7211 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7212 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7213 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7214
7215 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7216 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7217 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7218 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7219 }
7220
7221
7222 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7223
7224 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7225 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7226 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7227 --gerd. */
7228
7229 static void
7230 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7231 struct window *w;
7232 struct glyph_row *row;
7233 int width;
7234 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7235 {
7236 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7237 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7238
7239 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7240 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7241 and mini-buffer. */
7242 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7243 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7244 return;
7245
7246 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7247 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7248 the bar might not be in the window. */
7249 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7250 {
7251 struct glyph_row *row;
7252 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7253 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7254 }
7255 else
7256 {
7257 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7258 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7259 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7260 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7261 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7262 XGCValues xgcv;
7263
7264 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7265 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7266 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7267 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7268 that the glyph is legible. */
7269 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7270 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7271 else
7272 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7273 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7274
7275 if (gc)
7276 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7277 else
7278 {
7279 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7280 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7281 }
7282
7283 if (width < 0)
7284 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7285 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7286
7287 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7288 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7289
7290 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7291 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7292 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7293 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7294 width, row->height);
7295 else
7296 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7297 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7298 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7299 row->height - width),
7300 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7301 width);
7302
7303 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7304 }
7305 }
7306
7307
7308 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7309
7310 static void
7311 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7312 struct frame *f;
7313 Cursor cursor;
7314 {
7315 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7316 }
7317
7318
7319 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7320
7321 static void
7322 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7323 struct frame *f;
7324 int x, y, width, height;
7325 {
7326 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7327 x, y, width, height, False);
7328 }
7329
7330
7331 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7332
7333 static void
7334 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7335 struct window *w;
7336 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7337 int x, y;
7338 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7339 int on_p, active_p;
7340 {
7341 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7342
7343 if (on_p)
7344 {
7345 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7346 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7347
7348 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7349 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7350 {
7351 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7352 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7353 }
7354 else
7355 switch (cursor_type)
7356 {
7357 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7358 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7359 break;
7360
7361 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7362 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7363 break;
7364
7365 case BAR_CURSOR:
7366 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7367 break;
7368
7369 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7370 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7371 break;
7372
7373 case NO_CURSOR:
7374 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7375 break;
7376
7377 default:
7378 abort ();
7379 }
7380
7381 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7382 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7383 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7384 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7385 #endif
7386 }
7387
7388 #ifndef XFlush
7389 if (updating_frame != f)
7390 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7391 #endif
7392 }
7393
7394 \f
7395 /* Icons. */
7396
7397 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7398
7399 int
7400 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7401 struct frame *f;
7402 Lisp_Object file;
7403 {
7404 int bitmap_id;
7405
7406 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7407 return 1;
7408
7409 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7410 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7411 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7412 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7413
7414 if (STRINGP (file))
7415 {
7416 #ifdef USE_GTK
7417 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7418 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7419 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7420 return 0;
7421 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7422 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7423 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7424 }
7425 else
7426 {
7427 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7428 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7429 {
7430 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7431 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7432 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7433 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7434 }
7435
7436 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7437 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7438 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7439 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7440 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7441
7442 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7443 }
7444
7445 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7446 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7447
7448 return 0;
7449 }
7450
7451
7452 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7453 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7454
7455 int
7456 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7457 struct frame *f;
7458 char *icon_name;
7459 {
7460 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7461 return 1;
7462
7463 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7464 {
7465 XTextProperty text;
7466 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7467 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7468 text.format = 8;
7469 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7470 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7471 }
7472 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7473 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7474 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7475
7476 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7477 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7478 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7479 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7480
7481 return 0;
7482 }
7483 \f
7484 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7485
7486 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7487 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7488
7489 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7490
7491 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7492 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7493 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7494
7495 static void
7496 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7497 Display *display;
7498 XErrorEvent *error;
7499 {
7500 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7501 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7502 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7503 }
7504
7505 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7506 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7507 operating on.
7508
7509 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7510 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7511 stored in x_error_message_string.
7512
7513 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7514 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7515
7516 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7517
7518 void x_check_errors ();
7519 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7520
7521 int
7522 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7523 Display *dpy;
7524 {
7525 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7526
7527 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7528 XSync (dpy, False);
7529
7530 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7531 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7532 x_error_message_string));
7533
7534 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7535 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7536
7537 return count;
7538 }
7539
7540 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7541
7542 static Lisp_Object
7543 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7544 Lisp_Object old_val;
7545 {
7546 Lisp_Object first = XCAR (old_val);
7547 Display *dpy = XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer;
7548
7549 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7550 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7551 if (x_display_info_for_display (dpy) != 0)
7552 {
7553 BLOCK_INPUT;
7554 XSync (dpy, False);
7555 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7556 }
7557
7558 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7559 return Qnil;
7560 }
7561
7562 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7563 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7564 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7565
7566 void
7567 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7568 Display *dpy;
7569 char *format;
7570 {
7571 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7572 XSync (dpy, False);
7573
7574 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7575 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7576 }
7577
7578 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7579 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7580
7581 int
7582 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7583 Display *dpy;
7584 {
7585 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7586 XSync (dpy, False);
7587
7588 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7589 }
7590
7591 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7592
7593 void
7594 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7595 Display *dpy;
7596 {
7597 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7598 }
7599
7600 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7601 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7602 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7603 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7604
7605 void
7606 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7607 Display *dpy;
7608 int count;
7609 {
7610 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7611 }
7612
7613 #if 0
7614 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7615 x_trace_wire ()
7616 {
7617 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7618 }
7619 #endif /* ! 0 */
7620
7621 \f
7622 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7623 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7624 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7625 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7626 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7627
7628 static SIGTYPE
7629 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7630 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7631 {
7632 #ifdef USG
7633 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7634 must reestablish each time */
7635 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7636 #endif /* USG */
7637 }
7638
7639 \f
7640 /************************************************************************
7641 Handling X errors
7642 ************************************************************************/
7643
7644 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7645
7646 static char *error_msg;
7647
7648 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7649 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7650 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7651
7652 static void
7653 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7654 {
7655 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7656 exit (70);
7657 }
7658
7659 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7660 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7661
7662 static SIGTYPE
7663 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7664 Display *dpy;
7665 char *error_message;
7666 {
7667 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7668 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7669 int count;
7670
7671 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7672 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7673 handling_signal = 0;
7674
7675 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7676 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7677 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7678 the original message here. */
7679 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7680
7681 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7682 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7683 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7684
7685 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7686 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7687 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7688
7689 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7690 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7691
7692 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7693 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7694 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7695
7696 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7697 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7698 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7699 if (dpyinfo)
7700 {
7701 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7702 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7703 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7704 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7705 }
7706 #endif
7707
7708 #ifdef USE_GTK
7709 if (dpyinfo)
7710 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7711 #endif
7712
7713 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7714 if (dpyinfo)
7715 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7716
7717 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7718 that are on the dead display. */
7719 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7720 {
7721 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7722 minibuf_frame
7723 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7724 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7725 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7726 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7727 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7728 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7729 }
7730
7731 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7732 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7733 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7734 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7735 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7736 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7737 {
7738 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7739 trying to find a replacement. */
7740 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7741 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7742 }
7743
7744 if (dpyinfo)
7745 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7746
7747 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7748
7749 if (x_display_list == 0)
7750 {
7751 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7752 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7753 exit (70);
7754 }
7755
7756 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7757 #ifdef SIGIO
7758 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7759 #endif
7760 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7761 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7762
7763 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7764 error ("%s", error_msg);
7765 }
7766
7767
7768 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7769 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7770 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7771
7772 static void
7773 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7774 Display *display;
7775 XErrorEvent *error;
7776 {
7777 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7778
7779 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7780 original error handler. */
7781
7782 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7783 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7784 buf, error->request_code);
7785 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7786 }
7787
7788
7789 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7790 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7791
7792 static int
7793 x_error_handler (display, error)
7794 Display *display;
7795 XErrorEvent *error;
7796 {
7797 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7798 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7799 else
7800 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7801 return 0;
7802 }
7803
7804 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7805 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7806 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7807
7808 static int
7809 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7810 Display *display;
7811 {
7812 char buf[256];
7813
7814 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7815 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7816 return 0;
7817 }
7818 \f
7819 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7820
7821 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7822 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7823 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7824 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7825
7826 Lisp_Object
7827 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7828 struct frame *f;
7829 register char *fontname;
7830 {
7831 struct font_info *fontp
7832 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7833
7834 if (!fontp)
7835 return Qnil;
7836
7837 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7838 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7839 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7840
7841 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = fontp->average_width;
7842 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = fontp->space_width;
7843 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7844
7845 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7846
7847 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7848 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7849 {
7850 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7851 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7852 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7853 }
7854 else
7855 {
7856 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7857 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7858 }
7859
7860 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7861 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7862 {
7863 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7864 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7865 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7866 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7867 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7868 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7869
7870 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7871 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7872 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7873 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7874 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7875 }
7876
7877 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7878 }
7879
7880 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7881 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7882 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7883 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7884
7885 Lisp_Object
7886 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7887 struct frame *f;
7888 char *fontsetname;
7889 {
7890 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7891 Lisp_Object result;
7892
7893 if (fontset < 0)
7894 return Qnil;
7895
7896 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7897 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7898 to do. */
7899 return fontset_name (fontset);
7900
7901 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7902
7903 if (!STRINGP (result))
7904 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7905 return Qnil;
7906
7907 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7908 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7909
7910 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7911 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7912 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7913 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7914 #endif
7915
7916 return build_string (fontsetname);
7917 }
7918
7919 \f
7920 /***********************************************************************
7921 X Input Methods
7922 ***********************************************************************/
7923
7924 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7925
7926 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7927
7928 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7929 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7930 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7931
7932 static void
7933 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7934 XIM xim;
7935 XPointer client_data;
7936 XPointer call_data;
7937 {
7938 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7939 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7940
7941 BLOCK_INPUT;
7942
7943 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7944 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7945 {
7946 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7947 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7948 {
7949 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7950 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7951 }
7952 }
7953
7954 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7955 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7956 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7957 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7958 }
7959
7960 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7961
7962 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7963 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7964 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7965 #endif
7966
7967 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7968 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7969
7970 static void
7971 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7972 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7973 char *resource_name;
7974 {
7975 XIM xim;
7976
7977 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7978 if (use_xim)
7979 {
7980 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7981 EMACS_CLASS);
7982 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7983
7984 if (xim)
7985 {
7986 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7987 XIMCallback destroy;
7988 #endif
7989
7990 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7991 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7992
7993 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7994 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7995 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7996 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7997 #endif
7998 }
7999 }
8000
8001 else
8002 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8003 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8004 }
8005
8006
8007 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8008
8009 struct xim_inst_t
8010 {
8011 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8012 char *resource_name;
8013 };
8014
8015 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8016 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8017 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8018 when the callback was registered. */
8019
8020 static void
8021 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8022 Display *display;
8023 XPointer client_data;
8024 XPointer call_data;
8025 {
8026 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8027 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8028
8029 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8030 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8031 return;
8032
8033 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8034
8035 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8036 as they have no XIC. */
8037 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8038 {
8039 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8040
8041 BLOCK_INPUT;
8042 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8043 {
8044 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8045
8046 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8047 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8048 {
8049 create_frame_xic (f);
8050 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8051 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8052 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8053 {
8054 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8055 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8056 }
8057 }
8058 }
8059
8060 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8061 }
8062 }
8063
8064 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8065
8066
8067 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8068 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8069 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8070 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8071
8072 static void
8073 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8074 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8075 char *resource_name;
8076 {
8077 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8078 if (use_xim)
8079 {
8080 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8081 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8082 int len;
8083
8084 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8085 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8086 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8087 len = strlen (resource_name);
8088 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8089 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8090 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8091 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8092 xim_instantiate_callback,
8093 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8094 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8095 least, hence the configure test. */
8096 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8097 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8098 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8099 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8100 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8101
8102 }
8103 else
8104 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8105 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8106 }
8107
8108
8109 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8110
8111 static void
8112 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8113 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8114 {
8115 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8116 if (use_xim)
8117 {
8118 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8119 if (dpyinfo->display)
8120 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8121 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8122 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8123 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8124 if (dpyinfo->display)
8125 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8126 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8127 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8128 }
8129 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8130 }
8131
8132 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8133
8134
8135 \f
8136 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8137 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8138
8139 void
8140 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8141 struct frame *f;
8142 {
8143 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8144 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8145
8146 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8147 is already for the top-left corner. */
8148 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8149 return;
8150
8151 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8152 position that fits on the screen. */
8153 if (flags & XNegative)
8154 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8155 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos);
8156
8157 {
8158 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8159
8160 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8161 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8162 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8163
8164 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8165 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8166 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8167 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8168 is right, though.
8169
8170 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8171 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8172
8173 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8174 #endif
8175
8176 if (flags & YNegative)
8177 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - height + f->top_pos);
8178 }
8179
8180 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8181 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8182 so the flags should correspond. */
8183 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8184 }
8185
8186 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8187 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8188 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8189 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8190 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8191
8192 void
8193 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8194 struct frame *f;
8195 register int xoff, yoff;
8196 int change_gravity;
8197 {
8198 int modified_top, modified_left;
8199
8200 if (change_gravity > 0)
8201 {
8202 f->top_pos = yoff;
8203 f->left_pos = xoff;
8204 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8205 if (xoff < 0)
8206 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8207 if (yoff < 0)
8208 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8209 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8210 }
8211 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8212
8213 BLOCK_INPUT;
8214 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8215
8216 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8217 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8218
8219 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8220 {
8221 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8222 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8223 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8224 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8225 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8226 }
8227
8228 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8229 modified_left, modified_top);
8230
8231 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8232 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8233 {
8234 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8235 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8236 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8237 }
8238
8239 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8240 }
8241
8242 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8243 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8244 static void
8245 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8246 struct frame *f;
8247 {
8248 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8249 {
8250 int width, height, ign;
8251
8252 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8253
8254 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8255
8256 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8257 when setting WM manager hints.
8258 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8259 x_check_expected_move. */
8260 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8261 {
8262 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8263 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8264 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8265
8266 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8267 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8268 }
8269 }
8270 }
8271
8272 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8273 the window.
8274 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8275 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8276 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8277 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8278 static void
8279 x_check_expected_move (f)
8280 struct frame *f;
8281 {
8282 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8283 {
8284 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8285 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8286
8287 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8288 {
8289 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8290 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8291 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8292
8293 f->left_pos = expect_left;
8294 f->top_pos = expect_top;
8295 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 0);
8296 }
8297 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8298 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8299
8300 /* Just do this once */
8301 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8302 }
8303 }
8304
8305
8306 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8307 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8308 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8309 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8310
8311 static void
8312 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8313 struct frame *f;
8314 int change_gravity;
8315 int cols, rows;
8316 {
8317 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8318
8319 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8320 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8321 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8322 ? 0
8323 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8324 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8325 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8326
8327 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8328
8329 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8330 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8331
8332 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8333 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8334
8335 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8336 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8337 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8338
8339 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8340 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8341 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8342 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8343
8344 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8345 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8346 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8347 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8348 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8349
8350 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8351 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8352 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8353 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8354 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8355
8356 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8357 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8358 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8359 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8360 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8361
8362 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8363 }
8364
8365
8366 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8367 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8368 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8369 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8370
8371 void
8372 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8373 struct frame *f;
8374 int change_gravity;
8375 int cols, rows;
8376 {
8377 BLOCK_INPUT;
8378
8379 #ifdef USE_GTK
8380 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8381 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8382 else
8383 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8384 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8385
8386 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8387 {
8388 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8389 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8390 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8391 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8392 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8393 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8394 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8395 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8396 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8397 }
8398 else
8399 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8400
8401 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8402
8403 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8404
8405 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8406
8407 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8408 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8409
8410 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8411 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8412 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8413 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8414 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8415
8416 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8417 }
8418 \f
8419 /* Mouse warping. */
8420
8421 void
8422 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8423 struct frame *f;
8424 int x, y;
8425 {
8426 int pix_x, pix_y;
8427
8428 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8429 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8430
8431 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8432 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8433
8434 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8435 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8436
8437 BLOCK_INPUT;
8438
8439 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8440 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8441 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8442 }
8443
8444 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8445
8446 void
8447 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8448 struct frame *f;
8449 int pix_x, pix_y;
8450 {
8451 BLOCK_INPUT;
8452
8453 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8454 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8455 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8456 }
8457 \f
8458 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8459
8460 void
8461 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8462 struct frame *f;
8463 {
8464 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8465 x_raise_frame (f);
8466 #endif
8467 #if 0
8468 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8469 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8470 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8471 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8472 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8473 #endif /* ! 0 */
8474 }
8475
8476 void
8477 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8478 struct frame *f;
8479 {
8480 #if 0
8481 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8482 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8483 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8484 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8485 #endif /* ! 0 */
8486 }
8487
8488 /* Raise frame F. */
8489
8490 void
8491 x_raise_frame (f)
8492 struct frame *f;
8493 {
8494 if (f->async_visible)
8495 {
8496 BLOCK_INPUT;
8497 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8498 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8499 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8500 }
8501 }
8502
8503 /* Lower frame F. */
8504
8505 void
8506 x_lower_frame (f)
8507 struct frame *f;
8508 {
8509 if (f->async_visible)
8510 {
8511 BLOCK_INPUT;
8512 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8513 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8514 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8515 }
8516 }
8517
8518 static void
8519 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8520 FRAME_PTR f;
8521 int raise_flag;
8522 {
8523 if (raise_flag)
8524 x_raise_frame (f);
8525 else
8526 x_lower_frame (f);
8527 }
8528 \f
8529 /* Change of visibility. */
8530
8531 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8532 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8533 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8534 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8535 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8536 finishes with it. */
8537
8538 void
8539 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8540 struct frame *f;
8541 {
8542 Lisp_Object type;
8543 int original_top, original_left;
8544 int retry_count = 2;
8545
8546 retry:
8547
8548 BLOCK_INPUT;
8549
8550 type = x_icon_type (f);
8551 if (!NILP (type))
8552 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8553
8554 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8555 {
8556 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8557 call x_set_offset a second time
8558 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8559 before the window gets really visible. */
8560 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8561 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8562 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8563
8564 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8565
8566 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8567 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8568 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8569 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8570 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8571 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8572 #ifdef USE_GTK
8573 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8574 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8575 #else
8576 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8577 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8578 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8579 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8580 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8581 to come back ok without this. */
8582 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8583 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8584 #endif
8585 }
8586
8587 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8588
8589 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8590 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8591 so that incoming events are handled. */
8592 {
8593 Lisp_Object frame;
8594 int count;
8595 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8596 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8597 will set it when they are handled. */
8598 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8599
8600 original_left = f->left_pos;
8601 original_top = f->top_pos;
8602
8603 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8604 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8605
8606 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8607
8608 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8609 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8610 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8611 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8612
8613 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8614 because the window manager may choose the position
8615 and we don't want to override it. */
8616
8617 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8618 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8619 && previously_visible)
8620 {
8621 Drawable rootw;
8622 int x, y;
8623 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8624
8625 BLOCK_INPUT;
8626
8627 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8628 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8629 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8630 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8631 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8632 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8633 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8634 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8635 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8636
8637 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8638 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8639 original_left, original_top);
8640
8641 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8642 }
8643
8644 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8645
8646 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8647 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8648 MapNotify at all.. */
8649 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8650 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8651 {
8652 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8653 x_sync (f);
8654
8655 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8656 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8657 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8658 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8659 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8660 probably a bug. */
8661 if (input_polling_used ())
8662 {
8663 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8664 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8665 handler reset it. */
8666 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8667 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8668 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8669 poll_for_input_1 ();
8670 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8671 }
8672
8673 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8674 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8675 }
8676
8677 /* 2000-09-28: In
8678
8679 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8680 (iconify-frame f)
8681 (raise-frame f))
8682
8683 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8684 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8685 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8686 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8687
8688 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8689 goto retry;
8690 }
8691 }
8692
8693 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8694
8695 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8696
8697 void
8698 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8699 struct frame *f;
8700 {
8701 Window window;
8702
8703 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8704 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8705
8706 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8707 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8708 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8709
8710 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8711 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8712 return;
8713 #endif
8714
8715 BLOCK_INPUT;
8716
8717 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8718 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8719 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8720 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8721 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8722 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8723
8724 #ifdef USE_GTK
8725 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8726 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8727 else
8728 #endif
8729 {
8730 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8731
8732 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8733 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8734 {
8735 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8736 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8737 }
8738 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8739
8740 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8741 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8742 {
8743 XEvent unmap;
8744
8745 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8746 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8747 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8748 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8749 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8750 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8751 False,
8752 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8753 &unmap))
8754 {
8755 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8756 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8757 }
8758 }
8759
8760 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8761 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8762 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8763 }
8764
8765 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8766 just by the event that we get from the server.
8767 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8768 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8769 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8770 f->visible = 0;
8771 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8772 f->async_visible = 0;
8773 f->async_iconified = 0;
8774
8775 x_sync (f);
8776
8777 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8778 }
8779
8780 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8781
8782 void
8783 x_iconify_frame (f)
8784 struct frame *f;
8785 {
8786 int result;
8787 Lisp_Object type;
8788
8789 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8790 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8791 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8792
8793 if (f->async_iconified)
8794 return;
8795
8796 BLOCK_INPUT;
8797
8798 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8799
8800 type = x_icon_type (f);
8801 if (!NILP (type))
8802 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8803
8804 #ifdef USE_GTK
8805 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8806 {
8807 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8808 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8809
8810 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8811 f->iconified = 1;
8812 f->visible = 1;
8813 f->async_iconified = 1;
8814 f->async_visible = 0;
8815 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8816 return;
8817 }
8818 #endif
8819
8820 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8821
8822 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8823 {
8824 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8825 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8826 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8827 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8828 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8829 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8830 so we have to record it here. */
8831 f->iconified = 1;
8832 f->visible = 1;
8833 f->async_iconified = 1;
8834 f->async_visible = 0;
8835 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8836 return;
8837 }
8838
8839 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8840 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8841 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8842 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8843
8844 if (!result)
8845 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8846
8847 f->async_iconified = 1;
8848 f->async_visible = 0;
8849
8850
8851 BLOCK_INPUT;
8852 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8853 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8854 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8855
8856 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8857 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8858 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8859 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8860
8861 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8862 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8863
8864 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8865 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8866 {
8867 XEvent message;
8868
8869 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8870 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8871 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8872 message.xclient.format = 32;
8873 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8874
8875 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8876 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8877 False,
8878 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8879 &message))
8880 {
8881 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8882 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8883 }
8884 }
8885
8886 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8887 IconicState. */
8888 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8889
8890 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8891 {
8892 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8893 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8894 }
8895
8896 f->async_iconified = 1;
8897 f->async_visible = 0;
8898
8899 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8900 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8901 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8902 }
8903
8904 \f
8905 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8906
8907 void
8908 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8909 struct frame *f;
8910 {
8911 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8912 Lisp_Object bar;
8913 struct scroll_bar *b;
8914
8915 BLOCK_INPUT;
8916
8917 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8918 commands to the X server. */
8919 if (dpyinfo->display)
8920 {
8921 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8922 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8923
8924 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8925 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8926 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8927 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8928 toolkit scroll bars. */
8929 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8930 {
8931 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8932 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8933 }
8934 #endif
8935
8936 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8937 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8938 free_frame_xic (f);
8939 #endif
8940
8941 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8942 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8943 {
8944 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8945 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8946 }
8947 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8948 we are using a toolkit. */
8949 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8950 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8951
8952 free_frame_menubar (f);
8953 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8954
8955 #ifdef USE_GTK
8956 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8957 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8958 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8959 {
8960 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8961 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8962 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8963 }
8964 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8965
8966 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8967 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8968 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8969
8970 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8971 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8972 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8973 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8974 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8975 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8976
8977 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8978 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8979 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8980 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8981 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8982 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8983 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8984 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8985 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8986 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
8987 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
8988 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
8989 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
8990 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
8991 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
8992
8993 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
8994 free_frame_faces (f);
8995
8996 x_free_gcs (f);
8997 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8998 }
8999
9000 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9001 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9002
9003 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9004 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9005
9006 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9007 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9008 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9009 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9010 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9011 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9012
9013 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9014 {
9015 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9016 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9017 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9018 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9019 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9020 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9021 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9022 }
9023
9024 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9025 }
9026
9027
9028 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9029
9030 void
9031 x_destroy_window (f)
9032 struct frame *f;
9033 {
9034 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9035
9036 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9037 commands to the X server. */
9038 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9039 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9040
9041 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9042 }
9043
9044 \f
9045 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9046
9047 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9048 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9049 that the window now has.
9050 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9051 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9052 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9053
9054 #ifndef USE_GTK
9055 void
9056 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9057 struct frame *f;
9058 long flags;
9059 int user_position;
9060 {
9061 XSizeHints size_hints;
9062
9063 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9064 Arg al[2];
9065 int ac = 0;
9066 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9067 #endif
9068
9069 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9070
9071 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9072 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9073
9074 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9075 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9076
9077 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9078 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9079 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9080 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9081 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9082 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9083 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9084 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9085 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9086 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9087
9088 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9089 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9090 size_hints.max_width
9091 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9092 size_hints.max_height
9093 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9094
9095 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9096
9097 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9098 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9099 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9100 {
9101 int base_width, base_height;
9102 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9103
9104 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9105 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9106
9107 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9108
9109 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9110 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9111 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9112 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9113 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9114
9115 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9116 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9117 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9118
9119 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9120 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9121 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9122 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9123 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9124 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9125 #else
9126 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9127 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9128 #endif
9129 }
9130
9131 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9132 if (flags)
9133 {
9134 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9135 goto no_read;
9136 }
9137 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9138
9139 {
9140 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9141 long supplied_return;
9142 int value;
9143
9144 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9145 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9146 &supplied_return);
9147 #else
9148 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9149 #endif
9150
9151 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9152 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9153 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9154 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9155 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9156 #endif
9157
9158 if (flags)
9159 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9160 else
9161 {
9162 if (value == 0)
9163 hints.flags = 0;
9164 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9165 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9166 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9167 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9168 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9169 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9170 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9171 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9172 }
9173 }
9174
9175 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9176 no_read:
9177 #endif
9178
9179 #ifdef PWinGravity
9180 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9181 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9182
9183 if (user_position)
9184 {
9185 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9186 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9187 }
9188 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9189
9190 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9191 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9192 #else
9193 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9194 #endif
9195 }
9196 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9197
9198 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9199
9200 void
9201 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9202 struct frame *f;
9203 int state;
9204 {
9205 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9206 Arg al[1];
9207
9208 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9209 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9210 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9211 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9212
9213 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9214 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9215
9216 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9217 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9218 }
9219
9220 void
9221 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9222 struct frame *f;
9223 int pixmap_id;
9224 {
9225 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9226
9227 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9228 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9229 #endif
9230
9231 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9232 {
9233 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9234 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9235 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9236 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9237 }
9238 else
9239 {
9240 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9241 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9242 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9243 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9244 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9245 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9246 best to explicitly give up. */
9247 #if 0
9248 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9249 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9250 #else
9251 return;
9252 #endif
9253 }
9254
9255 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9256
9257 {
9258 Arg al[1];
9259 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9260 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9261 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9262 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9263 }
9264
9265 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9266
9267 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9268 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9269
9270 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9271 }
9272
9273 void
9274 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9275 struct frame *f;
9276 int icon_x, icon_y;
9277 {
9278 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9279
9280 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9281 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9282 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9283
9284 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9285 }
9286
9287 \f
9288 /***********************************************************************
9289 Fonts
9290 ***********************************************************************/
9291
9292 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9293
9294 struct font_info *
9295 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9296 FRAME_PTR f;
9297 int font_idx;
9298 {
9299 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9300 }
9301
9302
9303 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9304
9305 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9306 to be listed.
9307
9308 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9309
9310 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9311 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9312 on how many fonts to match. */
9313
9314 Lisp_Object
9315 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9316 struct frame *f;
9317 Lisp_Object pattern;
9318 int size;
9319 int maxnames;
9320 {
9321 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9322 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9323 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9324 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9325 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9326 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9327 int count;
9328 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9329
9330 if (size < 0)
9331 {
9332 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9333 size = 0;
9334 }
9335
9336 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9337 if (NILP (patterns))
9338 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9339
9340 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9341 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9342 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9343
9344 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9345 {
9346 int num_fonts;
9347 char **names = NULL;
9348
9349 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9350 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9351 The cache is an alist of the form:
9352 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9353 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9354 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9355 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9356 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9357 if (!NILP (list))
9358 {
9359 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9360 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9361 goto label_cached;
9362 }
9363
9364 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9365
9366 BLOCK_INPUT;
9367 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9368
9369 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9370 {
9371 XFontStruct *font;
9372 unsigned long value;
9373
9374 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9375 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9376 {
9377 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9378 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9379 font = NULL;
9380 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9381 }
9382
9383 if (font
9384 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9385 {
9386 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9387 int len = strlen (name);
9388 char *tmp;
9389
9390 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9391 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9392 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9393 if (len == 0)
9394 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9395 else
9396 {
9397 num_fonts = 1;
9398 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9399 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9400 simple var. */
9401 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9402 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9403 XFree (name);
9404 }
9405 }
9406 else
9407 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9408
9409 if (font)
9410 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9411 }
9412
9413 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9414 {
9415 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9416 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9417 if (maxnames < 0)
9418 {
9419 int limit;
9420
9421 for (limit = 500;;)
9422 {
9423 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9424 if (num_fonts == limit)
9425 {
9426 BLOCK_INPUT;
9427 XFreeFontNames (names);
9428 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9429 limit *= 2;
9430 }
9431 else
9432 break;
9433 }
9434 }
9435 else
9436 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9437 &num_fonts);
9438
9439 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9440 {
9441 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9442 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9443 names = NULL;
9444 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9445 }
9446 }
9447
9448 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9449 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9450
9451 if (names)
9452 {
9453 int i;
9454
9455 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9456 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9457 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9458 {
9459 int width = 0;
9460 char *p = names[i];
9461 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9462
9463 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9464 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9465 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9466 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9467 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9468 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9469 while (*p)
9470 if (*p++ == '-')
9471 {
9472 dashes++;
9473 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9474 width = atoi (p);
9475 else if (dashes == 9)
9476 resx = atoi (p);
9477 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9478 average_width = atoi (p);
9479 }
9480
9481 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9482 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9483 {
9484 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9485 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9486 {
9487 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9488 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9489 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9490 >= 0))
9491 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9492 width of this font. */
9493 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9494 else
9495 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9496 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9497 }
9498 }
9499 }
9500
9501 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9502 {
9503 BLOCK_INPUT;
9504 XFreeFontNames (names);
9505 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9506 }
9507 }
9508
9509 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9510 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9511 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9512
9513 label_cached:
9514 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9515
9516 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9517 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9518 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9519 {
9520 int found_size;
9521
9522 tem = XCAR (list);
9523
9524 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9525 continue;
9526 if (!size)
9527 {
9528 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9529 continue;
9530 }
9531
9532 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9533 {
9534 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9535 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9536 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9537
9538 BLOCK_INPUT;
9539 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9540 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9541 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9542 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9543 {
9544 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9545 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9546 thisinfo = NULL;
9547 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9548 }
9549 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9550 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9551
9552 if (thisinfo)
9553 {
9554 XSETCDR (tem,
9555 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9556 ? make_number (0)
9557 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9558 BLOCK_INPUT;
9559 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9561 }
9562 else
9563 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9564 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9565 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9566 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9567 }
9568
9569 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9570 if (found_size == size)
9571 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9572 else if (found_size > 0)
9573 {
9574 if (NILP (second_best))
9575 second_best = tem;
9576 else if (found_size < size)
9577 {
9578 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9579 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9580 second_best = tem;
9581 }
9582 else
9583 {
9584 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9585 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9586 second_best = tem;
9587 }
9588 }
9589 }
9590 if (!NILP (newlist))
9591 break;
9592 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9593 {
9594 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9595 break;
9596 }
9597 }
9598
9599 return newlist;
9600 }
9601
9602
9603 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9604
9605 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9606 font table. */
9607
9608 static void
9609 x_check_font (f, font)
9610 struct frame *f;
9611 XFontStruct *font;
9612 {
9613 int i;
9614 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9615
9616 xassert (font != NULL);
9617
9618 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9619 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9620 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9621 break;
9622
9623 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9624 }
9625
9626 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9627
9628 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9629 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9630 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9631 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9632 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9633
9634 static INLINE void
9635 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9636 XFontStruct *font;
9637 int *w, *h;
9638 {
9639 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9640 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9641
9642 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9643 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9644 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9645 if (*w <= 0)
9646 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9647 }
9648
9649
9650 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9651 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9652 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9653 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9654 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9655
9656 static int
9657 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9658 struct frame *f;
9659 {
9660 int i;
9661 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9662 XFontStruct *font;
9663 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9664 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9665
9666 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9667 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9668
9669 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9670 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9671 {
9672 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9673 int w, h;
9674
9675 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9676 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9677 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9678
9679 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9680 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9681 }
9682
9683 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9684 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9685
9686 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9687 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9688 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9689 }
9690
9691
9692 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9693 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9694 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9695 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9696
9697 struct font_info *
9698 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9699 struct frame *f;
9700 register char *fontname;
9701 int size;
9702 {
9703 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9704 Lisp_Object font_names;
9705 int count;
9706
9707 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9708 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9709 we already have by comparing names. */
9710 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9711
9712 if (!NILP (font_names))
9713 {
9714 Lisp_Object tail;
9715 int i;
9716
9717 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9718 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9719 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9720 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9721 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9722 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9723 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9724 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9725 }
9726
9727 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9728 {
9729 char *full_name;
9730 XFontStruct *font;
9731 struct font_info *fontp;
9732 unsigned long value;
9733 int i;
9734
9735 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9736 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9737 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9738 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9739 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9740 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9741 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9742
9743 BLOCK_INPUT;
9744 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9745 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9746 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9747 {
9748 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9749 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9750 font = NULL;
9751 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9752 }
9753 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9754 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9755 if (!font)
9756 return NULL;
9757
9758 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9759 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9760 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9761 break;
9762
9763 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9764 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9765 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9766 {
9767 int sz;
9768 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9769 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9770 dpyinfo->font_table
9771 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9772 }
9773
9774 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9775 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9776 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9777
9778 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9779 BLOCK_INPUT;
9780 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9781 fontp->font = font;
9782 fontp->font_idx = i;
9783 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9784 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9785
9786 if (font->min_bounds.width == font->max_bounds.width)
9787 {
9788 /* Fixed width font. */
9789 fontp->average_width = fontp->space_width = font->min_bounds.width;
9790 }
9791 else
9792 {
9793 XChar2b char2b;
9794 XCharStruct *pcm;
9795
9796 char2b.byte1 = 0x00, char2b.byte2 = 0x20;
9797 pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0);
9798 if (pcm)
9799 fontp->space_width = pcm->width;
9800 else
9801 fontp->space_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9802
9803 fontp->average_width
9804 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH, &value)
9805 ? (long) value / 10 : 0);
9806 if (fontp->average_width < 0)
9807 fontp->average_width = - fontp->average_width;
9808 if (fontp->average_width == 0)
9809 {
9810 if (pcm)
9811 {
9812 int width = pcm->width;
9813 for (char2b.byte2 = 33; char2b.byte2 <= 126; char2b.byte2++)
9814 if ((pcm = x_per_char_metric (font, &char2b, 0)) != NULL)
9815 width += pcm->width;
9816 fontp->average_width = width / 95;
9817 }
9818 else
9819 fontp->average_width = FONT_WIDTH (font);
9820 }
9821 }
9822
9823 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9824 full_name = 0;
9825 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9826 {
9827 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9828 char *p = name;
9829 int dashes = 0;
9830
9831 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9832 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9833 so don't use it.
9834 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9835 stored in them. */
9836 while (*p)
9837 {
9838 if (*p == '-')
9839 dashes++;
9840 p++;
9841 }
9842
9843 if (dashes >= 13)
9844 {
9845 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9846 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9847 }
9848
9849 XFree (name);
9850 }
9851
9852 if (full_name != 0)
9853 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9854 else
9855 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9856
9857 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9858 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9859
9860 if (NILP (font_names))
9861 {
9862 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9863 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9864 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9865 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9866 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9867 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9868 Qnil);
9869
9870 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9871 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9872 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9873 make_number (fontp->size)),
9874 Qnil)),
9875 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9876 if (full_name)
9877 {
9878 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9879 Qnil);
9880 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9881 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9882 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9883 make_number (fontp->size)),
9884 Qnil)),
9885 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9886 }
9887 }
9888
9889 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9890 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9891 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9892 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9893 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9894 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9895 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9896 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9897 fontp->encoding[1]
9898 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9899 /* 1-byte font */
9900 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9901 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9902 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9903 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9904 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9905 /* 2-byte font */
9906 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9907 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9908 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9909 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9910 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9911 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9912 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9913 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9914 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9915 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9916 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9917 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9918 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9919
9920 fontp->baseline_offset
9921 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9922 ? (long) value : 0);
9923 fontp->relative_compose
9924 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9925 ? (long) value : 0);
9926 fontp->default_ascent
9927 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9928 ? (long) value : 0);
9929
9930 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9931 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9932 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9933 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9934 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9935 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9936 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9937 return fontp;
9938 }
9939 }
9940
9941
9942 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9943 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9944
9945 struct font_info *
9946 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9947 struct frame *f;
9948 register char *fontname;
9949 {
9950 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9951 int i;
9952
9953 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9954 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9955 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9956 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9957 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9958 return NULL;
9959 }
9960
9961
9962 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9963 `encoder' of the structure. */
9964
9965 void
9966 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9967 struct font_info *fontp;
9968 {
9969 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9970
9971 elt = Qnil;
9972 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9973 {
9974 elt = XCAR (list);
9975 if (CONSP (elt)
9976 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9977 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9978 >= 0)
9979 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9980 >= 0)))
9981 break;
9982 }
9983
9984 if (! NILP (list))
9985 {
9986 struct ccl_program *ccl
9987 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9988
9989 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9990 xfree (ccl);
9991 else
9992 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9993 }
9994 }
9995
9996
9997 \f
9998 /***********************************************************************
9999 Initialization
10000 ***********************************************************************/
10001
10002 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10003 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
10004 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10005 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
10006
10007 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
10008 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10009 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
10010
10011 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10012 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10013 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10014 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10015 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10016 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
10017 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10018 };
10019 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10020
10021 static int x_initialized;
10022
10023 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10024 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10025 the screen number from the server number. */
10026 static int
10027 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10028 const char *name1, *name2;
10029 {
10030 int seen_colon = 0;
10031 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10032 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10033 int length_until_period = 0;
10034
10035 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10036 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10037 length_until_period++;
10038
10039 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10040 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10041 name1 += 4;
10042 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10043 name2 += 4;
10044 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10045 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10046 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10047 name1 += system_name_length;
10048 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10049 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10050 name2 += system_name_length;
10051 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10052 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10053 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10054 name1 += length_until_period;
10055 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10056 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10057 name2 += length_until_period;
10058
10059 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10060 {
10061 if (*name1 == ':')
10062 seen_colon++;
10063 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10064 return 1;
10065 }
10066 return (seen_colon
10067 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10068 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10069 }
10070 #endif
10071
10072 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10073 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10074 to 5. */
10075 static void
10076 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10077 unsigned long mask;
10078 int *bits;
10079 int *offset;
10080 {
10081 int nr = 0;
10082 int off = 0;
10083
10084 while (!(mask & 1))
10085 {
10086 off++;
10087 mask >>= 1;
10088 }
10089
10090 while (mask & 1)
10091 {
10092 nr++;
10093 mask >>= 1;
10094 }
10095
10096 *offset = off;
10097 *bits = nr;
10098 }
10099
10100 struct x_display_info *
10101 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10102 Lisp_Object display_name;
10103 char *xrm_option;
10104 char *resource_name;
10105 {
10106 int connection;
10107 Display *dpy;
10108 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10109 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10110
10111 BLOCK_INPUT;
10112
10113 if (!x_initialized)
10114 {
10115 x_initialize ();
10116 ++x_initialized;
10117 }
10118
10119 #ifdef USE_GTK
10120 {
10121 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10122 int argc;
10123 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10124 char **argv2 = argv;
10125 GdkAtom atom;
10126
10127 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10128 {
10129 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10130 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10131 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10132 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10133 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10134 }
10135 else
10136 {
10137 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10138 argv[argc] = 0;
10139
10140 argc = 0;
10141 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10142
10143 if (! NILP (display_name))
10144 {
10145 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10146 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10147 }
10148
10149 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10150 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10151
10152 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10153 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10154 #endif
10155
10156 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10157
10158 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10159 fixup_locale ();
10160 xg_initialize ();
10161
10162 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10163
10164 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10165 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10166
10167 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10168 {
10169 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10170 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10171 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10172
10173 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10174 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10175 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10176
10177 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10178 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10179
10180 UNGCPRO;
10181 }
10182
10183 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10184 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10185 }
10186 }
10187 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10188 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10189 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10190 errors with X11R5:
10191 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10192 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10193 So let's not use it until R6. */
10194 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10195 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10196 #endif
10197
10198 {
10199 int argc = 0;
10200 char *argv[3];
10201
10202 argv[0] = "";
10203 argc = 1;
10204 if (xrm_option)
10205 {
10206 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10207 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10208 }
10209 turn_on_atimers (0);
10210 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10211 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10212 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10213 &argc, argv);
10214 turn_on_atimers (1);
10215
10216 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10217 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10218 fixup_locale ();
10219 #endif
10220 }
10221
10222 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10223 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10224 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10225 #endif
10226 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10227 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10228 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10229
10230 /* Detect failure. */
10231 if (dpy == 0)
10232 {
10233 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10234 return 0;
10235 }
10236
10237 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10238
10239 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10240 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10241
10242 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10243 {
10244 struct x_display_info *share;
10245 Lisp_Object tail;
10246
10247 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10248 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10249 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10250 SDATA (display_name)))
10251 break;
10252 if (share)
10253 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10254 else
10255 {
10256 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10257 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10258 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10259 {
10260 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10261 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10262 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10263 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10264 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10265 BLOCK_INPUT;
10266 }
10267
10268 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10269 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10270 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10271 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10272 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10273 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10274 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10275 }
10276 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10277 }
10278 #endif
10279
10280 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10281 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10282 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10283
10284 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10285 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10286 x_display_name_list);
10287 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10288
10289 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10290
10291 #if 0
10292 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10293 #endif /* ! 0 */
10294
10295 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10296 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10297 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10298 + 2);
10299 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10300 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10301
10302 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10303 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10304
10305 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10306 #ifdef USE_GTK
10307 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10308 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10309 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10310
10311 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10312 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10313
10314 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10315 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10316 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10317 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10318 #else
10319 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10320 #endif
10321 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10322 all versions. */
10323 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10324
10325 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10326 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10327 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10328 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10329 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10330 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10331 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10332 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10333 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10334 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10335 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10336 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10337 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10338 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10339 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10340 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10341 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10342 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10343 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10344 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10345 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10346 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10347 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10348 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10349 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10350 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10351 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10352 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10353 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10354 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10355 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10356 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10357 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10358
10359 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10360 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10361 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10362
10363 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10364 {
10365 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10366 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10367 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10368 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10369 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10370 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10371 }
10372
10373 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10374 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10375 {
10376 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10377 {
10378 Lisp_Object value;
10379 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10380 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10381 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10382 Qnil, Qnil);
10383 if (STRINGP (value)
10384 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10385 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10386 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10387 }
10388 }
10389 else
10390 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10391 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10392
10393 {
10394 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10395 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10396 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10397 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10398 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10399 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10400 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10401 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10402 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10403 }
10404
10405 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10406 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10407 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10408 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10409 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10410 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10411 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10412 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10413 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10414 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10415 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10416 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10417 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10418 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10419 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10420 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10422 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10423 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10424 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10425 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10426 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10427 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10428 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10429 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10430 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10431 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10432 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10433 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10434 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10435 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10436 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10437 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10438 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10439 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10440 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10441 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10442 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10443 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10444 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10445 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10446 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10447 /* For properties of font. */
10448 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10449 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10450 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10451 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10452 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10453 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10454 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10455 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10456 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10457 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10458
10459 /* Ghostscript support. */
10460 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10461 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10462
10463 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10464 False);
10465
10466 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10467
10468 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10469 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10470
10471 {
10472 char null_bits[1];
10473
10474 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10475
10476 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10477 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10478 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10479 1);
10480 }
10481
10482 {
10483 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10484 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10485 dpyinfo->gray
10486 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10487 gray_bitmap_bits,
10488 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10489 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10490 }
10491
10492 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10493 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10494 #endif
10495
10496 #ifdef subprocesses
10497 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10498 if (connection != 0)
10499 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10500 #endif
10501
10502 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10503 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10504 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10505 /* stdin is a socket here */
10506 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10507 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10508 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10509 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10510 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10511 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10512
10513 #ifdef SIGIO
10514 if (interrupt_input)
10515 init_sigio (connection);
10516 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10517
10518 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10519 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10520 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10521 so that Xt does not crash. */
10522 {
10523 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10524 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10525 Font font;
10526 int count;
10527
10528 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10529 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10530 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10531 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10532 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10533 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10534 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10535 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10536 abort ();
10537 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10538 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10539 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10540 }
10541 #endif
10542 #endif
10543
10544 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10545 for debugging X code. */
10546 {
10547 Lisp_Object value;
10548 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10549 build_string ("synchronous"),
10550 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10551 Qnil, Qnil);
10552 if (STRINGP (value)
10553 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10554 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10555 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10556 }
10557
10558 {
10559 Lisp_Object value;
10560 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10561 build_string ("useXIM"),
10562 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10563 Qnil, Qnil);
10564 #ifdef USE_XIM
10565 if (STRINGP (value)
10566 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10567 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10568 use_xim = 0;
10569 #else
10570 if (STRINGP (value)
10571 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10572 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10573 use_xim = 1;
10574 #endif
10575 }
10576
10577 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10578 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10579 if (x_initialized == 1)
10580 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10581 #endif
10582
10583 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10584
10585 return dpyinfo;
10586 }
10587 \f
10588 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10589 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10590
10591 void
10592 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10593 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10594 {
10595 int i;
10596
10597 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10598
10599 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10600 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10601 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10602 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10603 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10604 else
10605 {
10606 Lisp_Object tail;
10607
10608 tail = x_display_name_list;
10609 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10610 {
10611 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10612 {
10613 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10614 break;
10615 }
10616 tail = XCDR (tail);
10617 }
10618 }
10619
10620 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10621 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10622
10623 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10624 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10625 else
10626 {
10627 struct x_display_info *tail;
10628
10629 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10630 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10631 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10632 }
10633
10634 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10635 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10636 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10637 #endif
10638 #endif
10639 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10640 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10641 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10642 #endif
10643 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10644 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10645 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10646 #endif
10647
10648 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10649 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10650 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10651 {
10652 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10653 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10654 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10655 }
10656
10657 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10658 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10659
10660 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10661 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10662 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10663 xfree (dpyinfo);
10664 }
10665
10666 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10667
10668 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10669 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10670 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10671 that slows us down. */
10672
10673 static void
10674 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10675 struct atimer *timer;
10676 {
10677 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10678 {
10679 BLOCK_INPUT;
10680 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10681 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10682 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10683 }
10684 }
10685
10686 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10687
10688 \f
10689 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10690
10691 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10692
10693 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10694 {
10695 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10696 x_produce_glyphs,
10697 x_write_glyphs,
10698 x_insert_glyphs,
10699 x_clear_end_of_line,
10700 x_scroll_run,
10701 x_after_update_window_line,
10702 x_update_window_begin,
10703 x_update_window_end,
10704 x_cursor_to,
10705 x_flush,
10706 #ifdef XFlush
10707 x_flush,
10708 #else
10709 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10710 #endif
10711 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10712 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10713 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10714 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10715 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10716 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10717 x_per_char_metric,
10718 x_encode_char,
10719 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10720 x_draw_glyph_string,
10721 x_define_frame_cursor,
10722 x_clear_frame_area,
10723 x_draw_window_cursor,
10724 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10725 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10726 };
10727
10728 void
10729 x_initialize ()
10730 {
10731 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10732
10733 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10734 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10735 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10736 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10737 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10738 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10739 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10740 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10741 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10742 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10743 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10744 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10745 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10746 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10747 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10748 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10749 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10750 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10751
10752 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10753 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10754 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10755 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10756 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10757 off the bottom */
10758 baud_rate = 19200;
10759
10760 x_noop_count = 0;
10761 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10762 any_help_event_p = 0;
10763 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10764
10765 #ifdef USE_GTK
10766 current_count = -1;
10767 #endif
10768
10769 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10770 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10771
10772 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10773 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10774
10775 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10776
10777 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10778 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10779 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10780 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10781 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10782 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10783 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10784
10785 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10786
10787 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10788 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10789 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10790 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10791 widgets don't behave normally. */
10792 {
10793 EMACS_TIME interval;
10794 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10795 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10796 }
10797 #endif
10798
10799 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10800 #ifndef USE_GTK
10801 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10802 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10803 #endif
10804 #endif
10805
10806 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10807 original error handler. */
10808 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10809 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10810
10811 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10812 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10813 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10814 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10815
10816 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10817 }
10818
10819
10820 void
10821 syms_of_xterm ()
10822 {
10823 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10824 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10825
10826 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10827 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10828
10829 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10830 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10831
10832 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10833 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10834
10835 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10836 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10837 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10838 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10839
10840 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10841 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10842
10843 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10844 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10845 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10846 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10847 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10848 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10849 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10850
10851 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10852 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10853 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10854 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10855 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10856 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10857 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10858 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10859 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10860
10861 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10862 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10863 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10864 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10865 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10866 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10867 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10868 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10869 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10870 #elif USE_GTK
10871 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10872 #else
10873 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10874 #endif
10875 #else
10876 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10877 #endif
10878
10879 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10880 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10881
10882 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10883 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10884 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10885 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10886 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10887 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10888 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10889 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10890 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10891
10892 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10893 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10894 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10895 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10896 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10897 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10898
10899 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10900 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10901 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10902 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10903 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10904 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10905
10906 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10907 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10908 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10909 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10910 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10911 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10912
10913 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10914 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10915 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10916 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10917 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10918 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10919
10920 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10921 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10922 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10923 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10924 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10925 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10926 }
10927
10928 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10929
10930 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10931 (do not change this comment) */